|  | /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ | 
|  | #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H | 
|  | #define __NET_CFG80211_H | 
|  | /* | 
|  | * 802.11 device and configuration interface | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> | 
|  | * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH | 
|  | * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH | 
|  | * Copyright (C) 2018-2021, 2023 Intel Corporation | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | #include <linux/ethtool.h> | 
|  | #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h> | 
|  | #include <linux/netdevice.h> | 
|  | #include <linux/debugfs.h> | 
|  | #include <linux/list.h> | 
|  | #include <linux/bug.h> | 
|  | #include <linux/netlink.h> | 
|  | #include <linux/skbuff.h> | 
|  | #include <linux/nl80211.h> | 
|  | #include <linux/if_ether.h> | 
|  | #include <linux/ieee80211.h> | 
|  | #include <linux/net.h> | 
|  | #include <linux/rfkill.h> | 
|  | #include <net/regulatory.h> | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * DOC: Introduction | 
|  | * | 
|  | * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges | 
|  | * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated | 
|  | * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used | 
|  | * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent | 
|  | * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers | 
|  | * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum | 
|  | * use restrictions. | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * DOC: Device registration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device | 
|  | * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs | 
|  | * described below. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each | 
|  | * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each | 
|  | * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with | 
|  | * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's | 
|  | * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes | 
|  | * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the | 
|  | * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating | 
|  | * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the | 
|  | * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has | 
|  | * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and | 
|  | * structures here describe these capabilities in detail. | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct wiphy; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* | 
|  | * wireless hardware capability structures | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes | 
|  | *	sending probe requests or beaconing. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel | 
|  | *	is not permitted. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel | 
|  | *	is not permitted. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band, | 
|  | *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this | 
|  | *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. | 
|  | *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth | 
|  | *	restrictions. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band, | 
|  | *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this | 
|  | *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. | 
|  | *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth | 
|  | *	restrictions. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted | 
|  | *	on this channel. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted | 
|  | *	on this channel. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted | 
|  | *	on this channel. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted | 
|  | *	on this channel. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted | 
|  | *	on this channel. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted | 
|  | *	on this channel. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted | 
|  | *	on this channel. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band, | 
|  | *	this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this | 
|  | *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. | 
|  | *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth | 
|  | *	restrictions. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum ieee80211_channel_flags { | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED		= 1<<0, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR		= 1<<1, | 
|  | /* hole at 1<<2 */ | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR		= 1<<3, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS	= 1<<4, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<5, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM		= 1<<6, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<7, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ	= 1<<8, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY	= 1<<9, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<10, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ		= 1<<11, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ		= 1<<12, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE		= 1<<13, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ		= 1<<14, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ		= 1<<15, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ		= 1<<16, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ		= 1<<17, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ		= 1<<18, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ	= 1<<19, | 
|  | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT		= 1<<20, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \ | 
|  | (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS) | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000 | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure describes a single channel for use | 
|  | * with cfg80211. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz | 
|  | * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz | 
|  | * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel | 
|  | * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags. | 
|  | * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory | 
|  | *	code to support devices with additional restrictions | 
|  | * @band: band this channel belongs to. | 
|  | * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi | 
|  | * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm) | 
|  | * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm) | 
|  | * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon | 
|  | *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon() | 
|  | *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band. | 
|  | * @orig_mag: internal use | 
|  | * @orig_mpwr: internal use | 
|  | * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required | 
|  | *	on this channel. | 
|  | * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. | 
|  | * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel { | 
|  | enum nl80211_band band; | 
|  | u32 center_freq; | 
|  | u16 freq_offset; | 
|  | u16 hw_value; | 
|  | u32 flags; | 
|  | int max_antenna_gain; | 
|  | int max_power; | 
|  | int max_reg_power; | 
|  | bool beacon_found; | 
|  | u32 orig_flags; | 
|  | int orig_mag, orig_mpwr; | 
|  | enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state; | 
|  | unsigned long dfs_state_entered; | 
|  | unsigned int dfs_cac_ms; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured | 
|  | * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for | 
|  | * different bands/PHY modes. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short | 
|  | *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and | 
|  | *	with CCK rates. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate | 
|  | *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the | 
|  | *	core code when registering the wiphy. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate | 
|  | *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the | 
|  | *	core code when registering the wiphy. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate | 
|  | *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the | 
|  | *	core code when registering the wiphy. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode. | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum ieee80211_rate_flags { | 
|  | IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<0, | 
|  | IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= 1<<1, | 
|  | IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= 1<<2, | 
|  | IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= 1<<3, | 
|  | IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= 1<<4, | 
|  | IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= 1<<5, | 
|  | IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= 1<<6, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum ieee80211_bss_type { | 
|  | IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS, | 
|  | IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS, | 
|  | IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, | 
|  | IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS, | 
|  | IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum ieee80211_privacy { | 
|  | IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON, | 
|  | IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF, | 
|  | IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\ | 
|  | ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can | 
|  | * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short | 
|  | * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are | 
|  | * passed around. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags | 
|  | * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps | 
|  | * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate | 
|  | * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when | 
|  | *	short preamble is used | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_rate { | 
|  | u32 flags; | 
|  | u16 bitrate; | 
|  | u16 hw_value, hw_value_short; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @enable: is the feature enabled. | 
|  | * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element. | 
|  | * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset | 
|  | * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use | 
|  | * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use | 
|  | * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by | 
|  | *	members of the SRG | 
|  | * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values | 
|  | *	used by members of the SRG | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd { | 
|  | bool enable; | 
|  | u8 sr_ctrl; | 
|  | u8 non_srg_max_offset; | 
|  | u8 min_offset; | 
|  | u8 max_offset; | 
|  | u8 bss_color_bitmap[8]; | 
|  | u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @color: the current color. | 
|  | * @enabled: HE BSS color is used | 
|  | * @partial: define the AID equation. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_he_bss_color { | 
|  | u8 color; | 
|  | bool enabled; | 
|  | bool partial; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure describes most essential parameters needed | 
|  | * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA | 
|  | * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec | 
|  | * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor | 
|  | * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing | 
|  | * @mcs: Supported MCS rates | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap { | 
|  | u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */ | 
|  | bool ht_supported; | 
|  | u8 ampdu_factor; | 
|  | u8 ampdu_density; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure describes most essential parameters needed | 
|  | * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA | 
|  | * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec | 
|  | * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap { | 
|  | bool vht_supported; | 
|  | u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25 | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure describes most essential parameters needed | 
|  | * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid. | 
|  | * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element. | 
|  | * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. | 
|  | * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap { | 
|  | bool has_he; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp; | 
|  | u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS | 
|  | * | 
|  | * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS | 
|  | * and NSS Set field" | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA. | 
|  | * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz | 
|  | * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz | 
|  | * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz | 
|  | * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp { | 
|  | union { | 
|  | struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz; | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320; | 
|  | } __packed bw; | 
|  | } __packed; | 
|  | } __packed; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		32 | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure describes most essential parameters needed | 
|  | * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid. | 
|  | * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element. | 
|  | * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. | 
|  | * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap { | 
|  | bool has_eht; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp; | 
|  | u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the | 
|  | * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the | 
|  | * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @types_mask: interface types mask | 
|  | * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities | 
|  | * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a | 
|  | *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value). | 
|  | * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities | 
|  | * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise | 
|  | * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data | 
|  | * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data { | 
|  | u16 types_mask; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap; | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | const u8 *data; | 
|  | unsigned int len; | 
|  | } vendor_elems; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and | 
|  | *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and | 
|  | *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and | 
|  | *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz | 
|  | *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz | 
|  | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz, | 
|  | *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config { | 
|  | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4, | 
|  | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5, | 
|  | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6, | 
|  | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7, | 
|  | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8, | 
|  | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9, | 
|  | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10, | 
|  | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11, | 
|  | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12, | 
|  | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13, | 
|  | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14, | 
|  | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure describes most essential parameters needed | 
|  | * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s) | 
|  | *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions. | 
|  | *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc. | 
|  | *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported. | 
|  | * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes | 
|  | *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_edmg { | 
|  | u8 channels; | 
|  | enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure describes most essential parameters needed | 
|  | * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA | 
|  | * @cap: S1G capabilities information | 
|  | * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap { | 
|  | bool s1g; | 
|  | u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */ | 
|  | u8 nss_mcs[5]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy | 
|  | * is able to operate in. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with | 
|  | *	in this band. | 
|  | * @band: the band this structure represents | 
|  | * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels | 
|  | * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with | 
|  | *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported | 
|  | *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM. | 
|  | * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates | 
|  | * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band | 
|  | * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band | 
|  | * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band | 
|  | * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band | 
|  | * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course) | 
|  | * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries | 
|  | * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in | 
|  | *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only | 
|  | *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of | 
|  | *	iftype_data). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_supported_band { | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *channels; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates; | 
|  | enum nl80211_band band; | 
|  | int n_channels; | 
|  | int n_bitrates; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap; | 
|  | u16 n_iftype_data; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype | 
|  | * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on | 
|  | * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * | 
|  | ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | 
|  | u8 iftype) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES)) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN) | 
|  | iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++)  { | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = | 
|  | &sband->iftype_data[i]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype)) | 
|  | return data; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype | 
|  | * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on | 
|  | * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * | 
|  | ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | 
|  | u8 iftype) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = | 
|  | ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (data && data->he_cap.has_he) | 
|  | return &data->he_cap; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities | 
|  | * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on | 
|  | * @iftype: the iftype to search for | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: the 6GHz capabilities | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline __le16 | 
|  | ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | 
|  | enum nl80211_iftype iftype) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = | 
|  | ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype | 
|  | * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on | 
|  | * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap * | 
|  | ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | 
|  | enum nl80211_iftype iftype) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = | 
|  | ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht) | 
|  | return &data->eht_cap; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful | 
|  | * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board | 
|  | * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable | 
|  | * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with | 
|  | * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make | 
|  | * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified | 
|  | * without affecting other devices. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev. | 
|  | * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first. | 
|  | * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register(). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | #ifdef CONFIG_OF | 
|  | void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  | #else /* CONFIG_OF */ | 
|  | static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy) | 
|  | { | 
|  | } | 
|  | #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */ | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* | 
|  | * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * DOC: Actions and configuration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration | 
|  | * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these | 
|  | * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these | 
|  | * operations use are described separately. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status | 
|  | * information via some functions that drivers need to call. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described | 
|  | * in a separate chapter. | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\ | 
|  | WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters | 
|  | * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise | 
|  | *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set | 
|  | * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames | 
|  | * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface. | 
|  | *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may | 
|  | *	determine the address as needed. | 
|  | *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the | 
|  | *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating | 
|  | **	only p2p devices with specified MAC. | 
|  | * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets | 
|  | *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed | 
|  | * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring | 
|  | *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct vif_params { | 
|  | u32 flags; | 
|  | int use_4addr; | 
|  | u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN]; | 
|  | const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups; | 
|  | const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct key_params - key information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Information about a key | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @key: key material | 
|  | * @key_len: length of key material | 
|  | * @cipher: cipher suite selector | 
|  | * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used | 
|  | *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian, | 
|  | *	length given by @seq_len. | 
|  | * @seq_len: length of @seq. | 
|  | * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero) | 
|  | * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct key_params { | 
|  | const u8 *key; | 
|  | const u8 *seq; | 
|  | int key_len; | 
|  | int seq_len; | 
|  | u16 vlan_id; | 
|  | u32 cipher; | 
|  | enum nl80211_key_mode mode; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition | 
|  | * @chan: the (control) channel | 
|  | * @width: channel width | 
|  | * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment | 
|  | * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment | 
|  | *	(only with 80+80 MHz) | 
|  | * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration. | 
|  | *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero), | 
|  | *	chan will define the primary channel and all other | 
|  | *	parameters are ignored. | 
|  | * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def { | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *chan; | 
|  | enum nl80211_chan_width width; | 
|  | u32 center_freq1; | 
|  | u32 center_freq2; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; | 
|  | u16 freq1_offset; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* | 
|  | * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask { | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | u32 legacy; | 
|  | u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN]; | 
|  | u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; | 
|  | u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; | 
|  | enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi; | 
|  | enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi; | 
|  | enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf; | 
|  | } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration | 
|  | * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration | 
|  | *	of the peer. | 
|  | * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify | 
|  | * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed, | 
|  | *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp. | 
|  | * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID | 
|  | * @retry_long: retry count value | 
|  | * @retry_short: retry count value | 
|  | * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation | 
|  | * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS | 
|  | * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation | 
|  | * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type | 
|  | * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_tid_cfg { | 
|  | bool config_override; | 
|  | u8 tids; | 
|  | u64 mask; | 
|  | enum nl80211_tid_config noack; | 
|  | u8 retry_long, retry_short; | 
|  | enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu; | 
|  | enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts; | 
|  | enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu; | 
|  | enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration | 
|  | * @peer: Station's MAC address | 
|  | * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied | 
|  | * @tid_conf: Configuration change info | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_tid_config { | 
|  | const u8 *peer; | 
|  | u32 n_tid_conf; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data | 
|  | * @macaddr: STA MAC address | 
|  | * @kek: FILS KEK | 
|  | * @kek_len: FILS KEK length | 
|  | * @snonce: STA Nonce | 
|  | * @anonce: AP Nonce | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_fils_aad { | 
|  | const u8 *macaddr; | 
|  | const u8 *kek; | 
|  | u8 kek_len; | 
|  | const u8 *snonce; | 
|  | const u8 *anonce; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping | 
|  | * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all | 
|  | *	addresses. | 
|  | * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address. | 
|  | *	Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp { | 
|  | const u8 *macaddr; | 
|  | bool enable; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef | 
|  | * @chandef: the channel definition | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given | 
|  | * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline enum nl80211_channel_type | 
|  | cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (chandef->width) { | 
|  | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: | 
|  | return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; | 
|  | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: | 
|  | return NL80211_CHAN_HT20; | 
|  | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: | 
|  | if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq) | 
|  | return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS; | 
|  | return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | WARN_ON(1); | 
|  | return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type | 
|  | * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill | 
|  | * @channel: the control channel | 
|  | * @chantype: the channel type | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Given a channel type, create a channel definition. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *channel, | 
|  | enum nl80211_channel_type chantype); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical | 
|  | * @chandef1: first channel definition | 
|  | * @chandef2: second channel definition | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are | 
|  | * identical, %false otherwise. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline bool | 
|  | cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan && | 
|  | chandef1->width == chandef2->width && | 
|  | chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 && | 
|  | chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset && | 
|  | chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @chandef: the channel definition | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline bool | 
|  | cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible | 
|  | * @chandef1: first channel definition | 
|  | * @chandef2: second channel definition | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible, | 
|  | * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_chan_def * | 
|  | cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid | 
|  | * @chandef: the channel definition to check | 
|  | * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against | 
|  | * @chandef: the channel definition to check | 
|  | * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set | 
|  | * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | u32 prohibited_flags); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against | 
|  | * @chandef: the channel definition to check | 
|  | * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype | 
|  | * Returns: | 
|  | *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | enum nl80211_iftype iftype); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition. | 
|  | * @msg: the msg to send channel definition | 
|  | * @chandef: the channel definition to check | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error | 
|  | **/ | 
|  | int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width | 
|  | * @width: the channel width of the channel | 
|  | * | 
|  | * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK | 
|  | * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags | 
|  | ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (width) { | 
|  | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: | 
|  | return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ; | 
|  | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: | 
|  | return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel | 
|  | * @chandef: channel definition for the channel | 
|  | * | 
|  | * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags | 
|  | ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef | 
|  | * | 
|  | * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel | 
|  | * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual | 
|  | * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @chandef: channel definition for the channel | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline int | 
|  | ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (chandef->width) { | 
|  | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: | 
|  | return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6, | 
|  | chandef->chan->max_power); | 
|  | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: | 
|  | return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3, | 
|  | chandef->chan->max_power); | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return chandef->chan->max_power; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for | 
|  | * @band_mask: which bands to check on | 
|  | * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable, | 
|  | *	%IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | unsigned long band_mask, | 
|  | u32 prohibited_flags); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in | 
|  | * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used | 
|  | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in | 
|  | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in | 
|  | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in | 
|  | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in | 
|  | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in | 
|  | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in | 
|  | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info | 
|  | * it has filled in during the get_survey(). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum survey_info_flags { | 
|  | SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0), | 
|  | SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1), | 
|  | SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2), | 
|  | SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3), | 
|  | SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4), | 
|  | SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5), | 
|  | SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6), | 
|  | SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7), | 
|  | SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8), | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct survey_info - channel survey response | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single | 
|  | *	record to report global statistics | 
|  | * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags | 
|  | * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are | 
|  | *	optional | 
|  | * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel) | 
|  | * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy | 
|  | * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy | 
|  | * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data | 
|  | * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data | 
|  | * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning | 
|  | * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure can later be expanded with things like | 
|  | * channel duty cycle etc. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct survey_info { | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *channel; | 
|  | u64 time; | 
|  | u64 time_busy; | 
|  | u64 time_ext_busy; | 
|  | u64 time_rx; | 
|  | u64 time_tx; | 
|  | u64 time_scan; | 
|  | u64 time_bss_rx; | 
|  | u32 filled; | 
|  | s8 noise; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES	10 | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings | 
|  | * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled | 
|  | *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions) | 
|  | * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset) | 
|  | * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers | 
|  | * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites | 
|  | * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites | 
|  | * @akm_suites: AKM suites | 
|  | * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., | 
|  | *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is | 
|  | *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by | 
|  | *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. | 
|  | * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be | 
|  | *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports | 
|  | * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port | 
|  | *	protocol frames. | 
|  | * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control | 
|  | *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. | 
|  | * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control | 
|  | *	port for mac80211 | 
|  | * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload) | 
|  | * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE | 
|  | *	offload) | 
|  | * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload) | 
|  | * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation: | 
|  | * | 
|  | *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED | 
|  | *	  Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any | 
|  | *	  preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in | 
|  | *	  such a scenario. | 
|  | * | 
|  | *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK | 
|  | *	  Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only | 
|  | * | 
|  | *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT | 
|  | *	  Allow hash-to-element only | 
|  | * | 
|  | *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH | 
|  | *	  Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_crypto_settings { | 
|  | u32 wpa_versions; | 
|  | u32 cipher_group; | 
|  | int n_ciphers_pairwise; | 
|  | u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES]; | 
|  | int n_akm_suites; | 
|  | u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES]; | 
|  | bool control_port; | 
|  | __be16 control_port_ethertype; | 
|  | bool control_port_no_encrypt; | 
|  | bool control_port_over_nl80211; | 
|  | bool control_port_no_preauth; | 
|  | const u8 *psk; | 
|  | const u8 *sae_pwd; | 
|  | u8 sae_pwd_len; | 
|  | enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set | 
|  | * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group. | 
|  | * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_mbssid_config { | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev; | 
|  | u8 index; | 
|  | bool ema; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames. | 
|  | * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements. | 
|  | * @elem.len: Length of data. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems { | 
|  | u8 cnt; | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | const u8 *data; | 
|  | size_t len; | 
|  | } elem[] __counted_by(cnt); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames. | 
|  | * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements. | 
|  | * @elem.len: Length of data. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_rnr_elems { | 
|  | u8 cnt; | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | const u8 *data; | 
|  | size_t len; | 
|  | } elem[] __counted_by(cnt); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data | 
|  | * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon | 
|  | * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE) | 
|  | *	or %NULL if not changed | 
|  | * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE) | 
|  | *	or %NULL if not changed | 
|  | * @head_len: length of @head | 
|  | * @tail_len: length of @tail | 
|  | * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL | 
|  | * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets | 
|  | * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response | 
|  | *	frames or %NULL | 
|  | * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets | 
|  | * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association | 
|  | *	Response frames or %NULL | 
|  | * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets | 
|  | * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp) | 
|  | * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only) | 
|  | * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements | 
|  | * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements | 
|  | * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change | 
|  | *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data) | 
|  | * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token | 
|  | *	(measurement type 8) | 
|  | * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement | 
|  | *	Token (measurement type 11) | 
|  | * @lci_len: LCI data length | 
|  | * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length | 
|  | * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings | 
|  | * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color | 
|  | *	attribute is present in beacon data or not. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_beacon_data { | 
|  | unsigned int link_id; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const u8 *head, *tail; | 
|  | const u8 *beacon_ies; | 
|  | const u8 *proberesp_ies; | 
|  | const u8 *assocresp_ies; | 
|  | const u8 *probe_resp; | 
|  | const u8 *lci; | 
|  | const u8 *civicloc; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies; | 
|  | s8 ftm_responder; | 
|  |  | 
|  | size_t head_len, tail_len; | 
|  | size_t beacon_ies_len; | 
|  | size_t proberesp_ies_len; | 
|  | size_t assocresp_ies_len; | 
|  | size_t probe_resp_len; | 
|  | size_t lci_len; | 
|  | size_t civicloc_len; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; | 
|  | bool he_bss_color_valid; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct mac_address { | 
|  | u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's | 
|  | *	entry specified by mac_addr | 
|  | * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed | 
|  | * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_acl_data { | 
|  | enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy; | 
|  | int n_acl_entries; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Keep it last */ | 
|  | struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from | 
|  | * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) | 
|  | * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) | 
|  | * @tmpl_len: Template length | 
|  | * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action | 
|  | *	frame headers. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_fils_discovery { | 
|  | u32 min_interval; | 
|  | u32 max_interval; | 
|  | size_t tmpl_len; | 
|  | const u8 *tmpl; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe | 
|  | *	response parameters in 6GHz. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned | 
|  | *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive | 
|  | *	scanning | 
|  | * @tmpl_len: Template length | 
|  | * @tmpl: Template data for probe response | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp { | 
|  | u32 interval; | 
|  | size_t tmpl_len; | 
|  | const u8 *tmpl; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used to configure an AP interface. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @chandef: defines the channel to use | 
|  | * @beacon: beacon data | 
|  | * @beacon_interval: beacon interval | 
|  | * @dtim_period: DTIM period | 
|  | * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from | 
|  | *	user space) | 
|  | * @ssid_len: length of @ssid | 
|  | * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames | 
|  | * @crypto: crypto settings | 
|  | * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy | 
|  | * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) | 
|  | * @smps_mode: SMPS mode | 
|  | * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity. | 
|  | * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window | 
|  | * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS | 
|  | * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for | 
|  | *	MAC address based access control | 
|  | * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG | 
|  | *	networks. | 
|  | * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons | 
|  | * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled) | 
|  | * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled) | 
|  | * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) | 
|  | * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled) | 
|  | * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled) | 
|  | * @ht_required: stations must support HT | 
|  | * @vht_required: stations must support VHT | 
|  | * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time | 
|  | * @he_required: stations must support HE | 
|  | * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE | 
|  | * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags | 
|  | * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings | 
|  | * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) | 
|  | * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters | 
|  | * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters | 
|  | * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid | 
|  | * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents | 
|  | *	a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel. | 
|  | *	Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ap_settings { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; | 
|  |  | 
|  | int beacon_interval, dtim_period; | 
|  | const u8 *ssid; | 
|  | size_t ssid_len; | 
|  | enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; | 
|  | bool privacy; | 
|  | enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; | 
|  | enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; | 
|  | int inactivity_timeout; | 
|  | u8 p2p_ctwindow; | 
|  | bool p2p_opp_ps; | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl; | 
|  | bool pbss; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper; | 
|  | bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required; | 
|  | bool twt_responder; | 
|  | u32 flags; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config; | 
|  | u16 punct_bitmap; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used for channel switch | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch | 
|  | * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch | 
|  | * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) | 
|  | * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response | 
|  | * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail) | 
|  | * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response | 
|  | * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel | 
|  | * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel | 
|  | * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing | 
|  | * @count: number of beacons until switch | 
|  | * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents | 
|  | *	a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel. | 
|  | *	Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_csa_settings { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa; | 
|  | const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon; | 
|  | const u16 *counter_offsets_presp; | 
|  | unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon; | 
|  | unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after; | 
|  | bool radar_required; | 
|  | bool block_tx; | 
|  | u8 count; | 
|  | u16 punct_bitmap; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used for bss color change | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown | 
|  | * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) | 
|  | * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response | 
|  | * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change | 
|  | * @count: number of beacons until the color change | 
|  | * @color: the color used after the change | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_color_change_settings { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change; | 
|  | u16 counter_offset_beacon; | 
|  | u16 counter_offset_presp; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next; | 
|  | u8 count; | 
|  | u8 color; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used to pass interface combination parameters | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want | 
|  | *	to use for verification | 
|  | * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel | 
|  | *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of | 
|  | *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths | 
|  | * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface | 
|  | *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum | 
|  | *	nl80211_iftype. | 
|  | * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface | 
|  | *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of | 
|  | *	the verification | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct iface_combination_params { | 
|  | int num_different_channels; | 
|  | u8 radar_detect; | 
|  | int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES]; | 
|  | u32 new_beacon_int; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply | 
|  | * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp) | 
|  | * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability | 
|  | * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling, | 
|  | * for those that don't these flags will are used. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum station_parameters_apply_mask { | 
|  | STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0), | 
|  | STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1), | 
|  | STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2), | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used to configure txpower for station. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power | 
|  | *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be | 
|  | *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx | 
|  | *	power per-interface or per-station. | 
|  | * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power | 
|  | *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC | 
|  | *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. | 
|  | *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for | 
|  | *	per peer TPC. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct sta_txpwr { | 
|  | s16 power; | 
|  | enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used to change and create a new link station. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station | 
|  | * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station) | 
|  | * @link_mac: MAC address of the link | 
|  | * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format | 
|  | *	(or NULL for no change) | 
|  | * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates | 
|  | * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station | 
|  | * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station | 
|  | * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification | 
|  | * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used | 
|  | * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station | 
|  | * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities | 
|  | * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station | 
|  | * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set | 
|  | * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station | 
|  | * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station | 
|  | * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct link_station_parameters { | 
|  | const u8 *mld_mac; | 
|  | int link_id; | 
|  | const u8 *link_mac; | 
|  | const u8 *supported_rates; | 
|  | u8 supported_rates_len; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa; | 
|  | u8 opmode_notif; | 
|  | bool opmode_notif_used; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa; | 
|  | u8 he_capa_len; | 
|  | struct sta_txpwr txpwr; | 
|  | bool txpwr_set; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa; | 
|  | u8 eht_capa_len; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station | 
|  | * @link_id: the link id | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct link_station_del_parameters { | 
|  | const u8 *mld_mac; | 
|  | u32 link_id; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct station_parameters - station parameters | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used to change and create a new station. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to | 
|  | * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed | 
|  | *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) | 
|  | * @sta_flags_set: station flags values | 
|  | *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) | 
|  | * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change | 
|  | * @aid: AID or zero for no change | 
|  | * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero) | 
|  | * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change | 
|  | * @plink_action: plink action to take | 
|  | * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station | 
|  | * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format | 
|  | *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field | 
|  | * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the | 
|  | *	QoS info field (but already shifted down) | 
|  | * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed | 
|  | *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value), | 
|  | *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask | 
|  | * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set | 
|  | *	to unknown) | 
|  | * @capability: station capability | 
|  | * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station | 
|  | * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities | 
|  | * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format | 
|  | * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels | 
|  | * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format | 
|  | * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes | 
|  | * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism | 
|  | * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station | 
|  | * @link_sta_params: link related params. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct station_parameters { | 
|  | struct net_device *vlan; | 
|  | u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set; | 
|  | u32 sta_modify_mask; | 
|  | int listen_interval; | 
|  | u16 aid; | 
|  | u16 vlan_id; | 
|  | u16 peer_aid; | 
|  | u8 plink_action; | 
|  | u8 plink_state; | 
|  | u8 uapsd_queues; | 
|  | u8 max_sp; | 
|  | enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; | 
|  | u16 capability; | 
|  | const u8 *ext_capab; | 
|  | u8 ext_capab_len; | 
|  | const u8 *supported_channels; | 
|  | u8 supported_channels_len; | 
|  | const u8 *supported_oper_classes; | 
|  | u8 supported_oper_classes_len; | 
|  | int support_p2p_ps; | 
|  | u16 airtime_weight; | 
|  | struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations | 
|  | * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal | 
|  | *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication) | 
|  | * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct station_del_parameters { | 
|  | const u8 *mac; | 
|  | u8 subtype; | 
|  | u16 reason_code; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified | 
|  | * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface | 
|  | * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still | 
|  | *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted) | 
|  | * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has | 
|  | *	the AP MLME in the device | 
|  | * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface | 
|  | * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station | 
|  | * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry | 
|  | *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when | 
|  | *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is | 
|  | *	supported/used) | 
|  | * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active | 
|  | *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace) | 
|  | * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed) | 
|  | * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum cfg80211_station_type { | 
|  | CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT, | 
|  | CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC, | 
|  | CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT, | 
|  | CFG80211_STA_AP_STA, | 
|  | CFG80211_STA_IBSS, | 
|  | CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP, | 
|  | CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE, | 
|  | CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL, | 
|  | CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on | 
|  | * @params: the new parameters for a station | 
|  | * @statype: the type of station being modified | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function | 
|  | * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that | 
|  | * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if | 
|  | * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for | 
|  | * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct station_parameters *params, | 
|  | enum cfg80211_station_type statype); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission | 
|  | * type for 802.11n transmissions. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum rate_info_flags { | 
|  | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0), | 
|  | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1), | 
|  | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2), | 
|  | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3), | 
|  | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4), | 
|  | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5), | 
|  | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG		= BIT(6), | 
|  | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS			= BIT(7), | 
|  | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS			= BIT(8), | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth | 
|  | * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum rate_info_bw { | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0, | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_5, | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_10, | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_40, | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_80, | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_160, | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU, | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_320, | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU, | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_1, | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_2, | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_4, | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_8, | 
|  | RATE_INFO_BW_16, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct rate_info - bitrate information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags | 
|  | * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg | 
|  | * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate | 
|  | * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only) | 
|  | * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw) | 
|  | * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi) | 
|  | * @he_dcm: HE DCM value | 
|  | * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc, | 
|  | *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU) | 
|  | * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4) | 
|  | * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi) | 
|  | * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc, | 
|  | *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct rate_info { | 
|  | u16 flags; | 
|  | u16 legacy; | 
|  | u8 mcs; | 
|  | u8 nss; | 
|  | u8 bw; | 
|  | u8 he_gi; | 
|  | u8 he_dcm; | 
|  | u8 he_ru_alloc; | 
|  | u8 n_bonded_ch; | 
|  | u8 eht_gi; | 
|  | u8 eht_ru_alloc; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission | 
|  | * type for 802.11n transmissions. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled | 
|  | * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled | 
|  | * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum bss_param_flags { | 
|  | BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= 1<<0, | 
|  | BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<1, | 
|  | BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= 1<<2, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Information about the currently associated BSS | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags | 
|  | * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS | 
|  | * @beacon_interval: beacon interval | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct sta_bss_parameters { | 
|  | u8 flags; | 
|  | u8 dtim_period; | 
|  | u16 beacon_interval; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID | 
|  | * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to | 
|  | *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled | 
|  | * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged | 
|  | * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged | 
|  | * @flows: number of new flows seen | 
|  | * @drops: total number of packets dropped | 
|  | * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE | 
|  | * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow | 
|  | * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow | 
|  | * @collisions: number of hash collisions | 
|  | * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued | 
|  | * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued | 
|  | * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_txq_stats { | 
|  | u32 filled; | 
|  | u32 backlog_bytes; | 
|  | u32 backlog_packets; | 
|  | u32 flows; | 
|  | u32 drops; | 
|  | u32 ecn_marks; | 
|  | u32 overlimit; | 
|  | u32 overmemory; | 
|  | u32 collisions; | 
|  | u32 tx_bytes; | 
|  | u32 tx_packets; | 
|  | u32 max_flows; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics | 
|  | * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to | 
|  | *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled | 
|  | * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs | 
|  | * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs | 
|  | * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for | 
|  | *	transmitted MSDUs | 
|  | * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs | 
|  | * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_tid_stats { | 
|  | u32 filled; | 
|  | u64 rx_msdu; | 
|  | u64 tx_msdu; | 
|  | u64 tx_msdu_retries; | 
|  | u64 tx_msdu_failed; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4 | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct station_info - station information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to | 
|  | *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them | 
|  | * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected | 
|  | * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds | 
|  | * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association | 
|  | * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station | 
|  | * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station | 
|  | * @llid: mesh local link id | 
|  | * @plid: mesh peer link id | 
|  | * @plink_state: mesh peer link state | 
|  | * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. | 
|  | *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. | 
|  | * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. | 
|  | *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. | 
|  | * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg | 
|  | * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm | 
|  | * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm | 
|  | * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station | 
|  | * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station | 
|  | * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station | 
|  | * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station | 
|  | * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs) | 
|  | * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK) | 
|  | * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason. | 
|  | * @bss_param: current BSS parameters | 
|  | * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. | 
|  | *	This number should increase every time the list of stations | 
|  | *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that | 
|  | *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. | 
|  | * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request. | 
|  | *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use | 
|  | *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for | 
|  | *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. | 
|  | * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets. | 
|  | * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values | 
|  | * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered. | 
|  | * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host. | 
|  | * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode | 
|  | * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode | 
|  | * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode | 
|  | * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers) | 
|  | *	towards this station. | 
|  | * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer | 
|  | * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received | 
|  | *	from this peer | 
|  | * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate | 
|  | * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer | 
|  | * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer | 
|  | * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight | 
|  | * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last | 
|  | *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs. | 
|  | *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL. | 
|  | * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame. | 
|  | * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has | 
|  | *	been sent. | 
|  | * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station | 
|  | * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with | 
|  | *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the | 
|  | *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address. | 
|  | * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric. | 
|  | * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server | 
|  | * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled | 
|  | *	by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP | 
|  | *	MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this | 
|  | *	information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and | 
|  | *	dump_station() callbacks. | 
|  | * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station | 
|  | *	completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO | 
|  | *	and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. | 
|  | * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station. | 
|  | *	For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros. | 
|  | * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response. | 
|  | *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user | 
|  | *	space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the | 
|  | *	cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't | 
|  | *	fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and | 
|  | *	dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine | 
|  | *	the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station. | 
|  | * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct station_info { | 
|  | u64 filled; | 
|  | u32 connected_time; | 
|  | u32 inactive_time; | 
|  | u64 assoc_at; | 
|  | u64 rx_bytes; | 
|  | u64 tx_bytes; | 
|  | u16 llid; | 
|  | u16 plid; | 
|  | u8 plink_state; | 
|  | s8 signal; | 
|  | s8 signal_avg; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 chains; | 
|  | s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; | 
|  | s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct rate_info txrate; | 
|  | struct rate_info rxrate; | 
|  | u32 rx_packets; | 
|  | u32 tx_packets; | 
|  | u32 tx_retries; | 
|  | u32 tx_failed; | 
|  | u32 rx_dropped_misc; | 
|  | struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param; | 
|  | struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags; | 
|  |  | 
|  | int generation; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const u8 *assoc_req_ies; | 
|  | size_t assoc_req_ies_len; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 beacon_loss_count; | 
|  | s64 t_offset; | 
|  | enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; | 
|  | enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm; | 
|  | enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 expected_throughput; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u64 tx_duration; | 
|  | u64 rx_duration; | 
|  | u64 rx_beacon; | 
|  | u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg; | 
|  | u8 connected_to_gate; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid; | 
|  | s8 ack_signal; | 
|  | s8 avg_ack_signal; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u16 airtime_weight; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 rx_mpdu_count; | 
|  | u32 fcs_err_count; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 airtime_link_metric; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 connected_to_as; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool mlo_params_valid; | 
|  | u8 assoc_link_id; | 
|  | u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | const u8 *assoc_resp_ies; | 
|  | size_t assoc_resp_ies_len; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit | 
|  | * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm | 
|  | * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs { | 
|  | s32 power; | 
|  | u32 freq_range_index; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs | 
|  | * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types | 
|  | * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs | 
|  | * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_sar_specs { | 
|  | enum nl80211_sar_type type; | 
|  | u32 num_sub_specs; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges | 
|  | * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency | 
|  | * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges { | 
|  | u32 start_freq; | 
|  | u32 end_freq; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability | 
|  | * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types | 
|  | * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges | 
|  | * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing | 
|  | * range to small ones and then append them. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_sar_capa { | 
|  | enum nl80211_sar_type type; | 
|  | u32 num_freq_ranges; | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station | 
|  | * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to | 
|  | * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest | 
|  | * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information | 
|  | * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be | 
|  | * considered undefined. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, | 
|  | struct station_info *sinfo); | 
|  | #else | 
|  | static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *mac_addr, | 
|  | struct station_info *sinfo) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return -ENOENT; | 
|  | } | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits | 
|  | * according to the nl80211 flags. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed | 
|  | * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS | 
|  | * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP | 
|  | * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames | 
|  | * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering | 
|  | * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing | 
|  | * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum monitor_flags { | 
|  | MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, | 
|  | MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, | 
|  | MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, | 
|  | MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, | 
|  | MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, | 
|  | MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, | 
|  | MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled | 
|  | * in during get_station() or dump_station(). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled | 
|  | * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled | 
|  | * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled | 
|  | * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled | 
|  | * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled | 
|  | * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled | 
|  | * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled | 
|  | * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled | 
|  | * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum mpath_info_flags { | 
|  | MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0), | 
|  | MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1), | 
|  | MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2), | 
|  | MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3), | 
|  | MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4), | 
|  | MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5), | 
|  | MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6), | 
|  | MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7), | 
|  | MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8), | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct mpath_info - mesh path information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath(). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags | 
|  | * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination | 
|  | * @sn: target sequence number | 
|  | * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path | 
|  | * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs | 
|  | * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags | 
|  | * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs | 
|  | * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries | 
|  | * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. | 
|  | *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths | 
|  | *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that | 
|  | *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. | 
|  | * @hop_count: hops to destination | 
|  | * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct mpath_info { | 
|  | u32 filled; | 
|  | u32 frame_qlen; | 
|  | u32 sn; | 
|  | u32 metric; | 
|  | u32 exptime; | 
|  | u32 discovery_timeout; | 
|  | u8 discovery_retries; | 
|  | u8 flags; | 
|  | u8 hop_count; | 
|  | u32 path_change_count; | 
|  |  | 
|  | int generation; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD | 
|  | * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection | 
|  | *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) | 
|  | * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed | 
|  | *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) | 
|  | * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed | 
|  | *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) | 
|  | * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format | 
|  | *	(or NULL for no change) | 
|  | * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates | 
|  | * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations | 
|  | *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) | 
|  | * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode | 
|  | *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change) | 
|  | * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change) | 
|  | * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct bss_parameters { | 
|  | int link_id; | 
|  | int use_cts_prot; | 
|  | int use_short_preamble; | 
|  | int use_short_slot_time; | 
|  | const u8 *basic_rates; | 
|  | u8 basic_rates_len; | 
|  | int ap_isolate; | 
|  | int ht_opmode; | 
|  | s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used | 
|  | *	by the Mesh Peering Open message | 
|  | * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units | 
|  | *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message | 
|  | * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by | 
|  | *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering | 
|  | * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this | 
|  | *	mesh interface | 
|  | * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can | 
|  | *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh | 
|  | * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA | 
|  | * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection | 
|  | *	elements | 
|  | * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we | 
|  | *	detect compatible mesh peers | 
|  | * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to | 
|  | *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method | 
|  | * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ | 
|  | *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target | 
|  | * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds | 
|  | * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on | 
|  | *	a path discovery in milliseconds | 
|  | * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs | 
|  | *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the | 
|  | *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit) | 
|  | * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during | 
|  | *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ | 
|  | *	element | 
|  | * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during | 
|  | *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR | 
|  | *	element | 
|  | * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that | 
|  | *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh | 
|  | * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA | 
|  | * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root | 
|  | *	announcements are transmitted | 
|  | * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh | 
|  | *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is | 
|  | *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true | 
|  | *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but | 
|  | *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the | 
|  | *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec) | 
|  | * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding | 
|  | *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) | 
|  | * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate | 
|  | *	station to establish a peer link | 
|  | * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs | 
|  | *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to | 
|  | *	the root mesh STA to be valid. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive | 
|  | *	PREQs are transmitted. | 
|  | * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs) | 
|  | *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing | 
|  | *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation. | 
|  | * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial | 
|  | *	setting for new peer links. | 
|  | * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake | 
|  | *	after transmitting its beacon. | 
|  | * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established | 
|  | *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it | 
|  | *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes. | 
|  | * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA | 
|  | *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server | 
|  | *	in the mesh formation field. | 
|  | * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is | 
|  | *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the | 
|  | *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths | 
|  | *      in the mesh path table | 
|  | * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP | 
|  | *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might | 
|  | *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So | 
|  | *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable | 
|  | *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct mesh_config { | 
|  | u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout; | 
|  | u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout; | 
|  | u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout; | 
|  | u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks; | 
|  | u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries; | 
|  | u8 dot11MeshTTL; | 
|  | u8 element_ttl; | 
|  | bool auto_open_plinks; | 
|  | u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor; | 
|  | u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries; | 
|  | u32 path_refresh_time; | 
|  | u16 min_discovery_timeout; | 
|  | u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout; | 
|  | u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval; | 
|  | u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval; | 
|  | u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime; | 
|  | u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode; | 
|  | bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate; | 
|  | bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer; | 
|  | u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval; | 
|  | bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol; | 
|  | bool dot11MeshForwarding; | 
|  | s32 rssi_threshold; | 
|  | u16 ht_opmode; | 
|  | u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout; | 
|  | u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval; | 
|  | u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval; | 
|  | enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode; | 
|  | u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration; | 
|  | u32 plink_timeout; | 
|  | bool dot11MeshNolearn; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration | 
|  | * @chandef: defines the channel to use | 
|  | * @mesh_id: the mesh ID | 
|  | * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes | 
|  | * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use | 
|  | * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use | 
|  | * @path_metric: which metric to use | 
|  | * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using | 
|  | * @ie: vendor information elements (optional) | 
|  | * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements | 
|  | * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication | 
|  | * @is_secure: this mesh uses security | 
|  | * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions | 
|  | * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use | 
|  | * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use | 
|  | * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a] | 
|  | * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh | 
|  | * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons | 
|  | * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. | 
|  | *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required | 
|  | *	to operate on DFS channels. | 
|  | * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control | 
|  | *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct mesh_setup { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | 
|  | const u8 *mesh_id; | 
|  | u8 mesh_id_len; | 
|  | u8 sync_method; | 
|  | u8 path_sel_proto; | 
|  | u8 path_metric; | 
|  | u8 auth_id; | 
|  | const u8 *ie; | 
|  | u8 ie_len; | 
|  | bool is_authenticated; | 
|  | bool is_secure; | 
|  | bool user_mpm; | 
|  | u8 dtim_period; | 
|  | u16 beacon_interval; | 
|  | int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; | 
|  | u32 basic_rates; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; | 
|  | bool userspace_handles_dfs; | 
|  | bool control_port_over_nl80211; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration | 
|  | * @chandef: defines the channel to use | 
|  | * | 
|  | * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ocb_setup { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters | 
|  | * @ac: AC identifier | 
|  | * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled | 
|  | * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range | 
|  | *	1..32767] | 
|  | * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range | 
|  | *	1..32767] | 
|  | * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] | 
|  | * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_txq_params { | 
|  | enum nl80211_ac ac; | 
|  | u16 txop; | 
|  | u16 cwmin; | 
|  | u16 cwmax; | 
|  | u8 aifs; | 
|  | int link_id; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite | 
|  | * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will | 
|  | * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the | 
|  | * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the | 
|  | * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to | 
|  | * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements | 
|  | * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be | 
|  | * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised | 
|  | * in the wiphy structure. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because | 
|  | * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not | 
|  | * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of | 
|  | * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the | 
|  | * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available | 
|  | * to userspace. | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description | 
|  | * @ssid: the SSID | 
|  | * @ssid_len: length of the ssid | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ssid { | 
|  | u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; | 
|  | u8 ssid_len; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan | 
|  | * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the | 
|  | *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this | 
|  | *	information is not available, this field is left zero. | 
|  | * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set. | 
|  | * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason, | 
|  | *	userspace will be notified of that | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_scan_info { | 
|  | u64 scan_start_tsf; | 
|  | u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | bool aborted; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for | 
|  | * @bssid: bssid to scan for | 
|  | * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request | 
|  | *	 which the above info relvant to | 
|  | * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU | 
|  | * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used | 
|  | * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait | 
|  | *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests. | 
|  | * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params { | 
|  | u32 short_ssid; | 
|  | u32 channel_idx; | 
|  | u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; | 
|  | bool unsolicited_probe; | 
|  | bool short_ssid_valid; | 
|  | bool psc_no_listen; | 
|  | s8 psd_20; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only) | 
|  | * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs | 
|  | * @channels: channels to scan on. | 
|  | * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan | 
|  | * @scan_width: channel width for scanning | 
|  | * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL | 
|  | * @ie_len: length of ie in octets | 
|  | * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If | 
|  | *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and | 
|  | *	the actual dwell time may be shorter. | 
|  | * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the | 
|  | *	%duration field. | 
|  | * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags | 
|  | * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for | 
|  | * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started | 
|  | * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for | 
|  | * @info: (internal) information about completed scan | 
|  | * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted | 
|  | * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band | 
|  | * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation | 
|  | * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that | 
|  | *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should | 
|  | *	be taken from the @mac_addr | 
|  | * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only, | 
|  | *	true if this is the second scan request | 
|  | * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params | 
|  | * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params | 
|  | * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_scan_request { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; | 
|  | int n_ssids; | 
|  | u32 n_channels; | 
|  | enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; | 
|  | const u8 *ie; | 
|  | size_t ie_len; | 
|  | u16 duration; | 
|  | bool duration_mandatory; | 
|  | u32 flags; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* internal */ | 
|  | struct wiphy *wiphy; | 
|  | unsigned long scan_start; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_scan_info info; | 
|  | bool notified; | 
|  | bool no_cck; | 
|  | bool scan_6ghz; | 
|  | u32 n_6ghz_params; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* keep last */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN); | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) { | 
|  | buf[i] &= ~mask[i]; | 
|  | buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i]; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match | 
|  | *	or no match (RSSI only) | 
|  | * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match | 
|  | *	or no match (RSSI only) | 
|  | * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm) | 
|  | * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied | 
|  | *	for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support | 
|  | *	of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability | 
|  | *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band | 
|  | *	specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified. | 
|  | *	If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of | 
|  | *	corresponding matchset. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_match_set { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; | 
|  | u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; | 
|  | s32 rssi_thold; | 
|  | s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds. | 
|  | * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means | 
|  | *	infinite loop. | 
|  | *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero, | 
|  | *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan { | 
|  | u32 interval; | 
|  | u32 iterations; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment. | 
|  | * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust { | 
|  | enum nl80211_band band; | 
|  | s8 delta; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @reqid: identifies this request. | 
|  | * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans) | 
|  | * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs | 
|  | * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan | 
|  | * @scan_width: channel width for scanning | 
|  | * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL | 
|  | * @ie_len: length of ie in octets | 
|  | * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags | 
|  | * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result | 
|  | *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host | 
|  | *	(others are filtered out). | 
|  | *	If ommited, all results are passed. | 
|  | * @n_match_sets: number of match sets | 
|  | * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for | 
|  | * @dev: the interface | 
|  | * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan | 
|  | * @channels: channels to scan | 
|  | * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this | 
|  | *	contains the minimum over all matchsets | 
|  | * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation | 
|  | * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that | 
|  | *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should | 
|  | *	be taken from the @mac_addr | 
|  | * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest | 
|  | *	index must be executed first. | 
|  | * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1. | 
|  | * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct | 
|  | * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request | 
|  | *	owned by a particular socket) | 
|  | * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed | 
|  | * @list: for keeping list of requests. | 
|  | * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan | 
|  | *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start | 
|  | *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not | 
|  | *	supported. | 
|  | * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not. | 
|  | * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result | 
|  | *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined | 
|  | *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS. | 
|  | *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state. | 
|  | * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong | 
|  | *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported | 
|  | *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that | 
|  | *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative | 
|  | *	comparisions. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request { | 
|  | u64 reqid; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; | 
|  | int n_ssids; | 
|  | u32 n_channels; | 
|  | enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; | 
|  | const u8 *ie; | 
|  | size_t ie_len; | 
|  | u32 flags; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets; | 
|  | int n_match_sets; | 
|  | s32 min_rssi_thold; | 
|  | u32 delay; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans; | 
|  | int n_scan_plans; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool relative_rssi_set; | 
|  | s8 relative_rssi; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* internal */ | 
|  | struct wiphy *wiphy; | 
|  | struct net_device *dev; | 
|  | unsigned long scan_start; | 
|  | bool report_results; | 
|  | struct rcu_head rcu_head; | 
|  | u32 owner_nlportid; | 
|  | bool nl_owner_dead; | 
|  | struct list_head list; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* keep last */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available | 
|  | * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm) | 
|  | * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100 | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum cfg80211_signal_type { | 
|  | CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE, | 
|  | CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, | 
|  | CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data | 
|  | * @chan: channel the frame was received on | 
|  | * @scan_width: scan width that was used | 
|  | * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's | 
|  | *	signal type | 
|  | * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was | 
|  | *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually | 
|  | *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was | 
|  | *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms. | 
|  | *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of | 
|  | *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate. | 
|  | * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the | 
|  | *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified | 
|  | *	by %parent_bssid. | 
|  | * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to | 
|  | *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received. | 
|  | * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. | 
|  | * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. | 
|  | * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_inform_bss { | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *chan; | 
|  | enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; | 
|  | s32 signal; | 
|  | u64 boottime_ns; | 
|  | u64 parent_tsf; | 
|  | u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | u8 chains; | 
|  | s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | void *drv_data; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data | 
|  | * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs | 
|  | * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing | 
|  | * @len: length of the IEs | 
|  | * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon | 
|  | * @data: IE data | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss_ies { | 
|  | u64 tsf; | 
|  | struct rcu_head rcu_head; | 
|  | int len; | 
|  | bool from_beacon; | 
|  | u8 data[]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network) | 
|  | * for use in scan results and similar. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @channel: channel this BSS is on | 
|  | * @scan_width: width of the control channel | 
|  | * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS | 
|  | * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame | 
|  | * @capability: the capability field in host byte order | 
|  | * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these | 
|  | *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or | 
|  | *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been | 
|  | *	received. It is always non-%NULL. | 
|  | * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame | 
|  | *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't | 
|  | *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the | 
|  | *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct) | 
|  | * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame | 
|  | * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from | 
|  | *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct | 
|  | *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and | 
|  | *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case. | 
|  | * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a | 
|  | *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support) | 
|  | * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one | 
|  | *	(multi-BSSID support) | 
|  | * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type) | 
|  | * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. | 
|  | * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. | 
|  | * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set | 
|  | * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set | 
|  | * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss { | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *channel; | 
|  | enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies; | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies; | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss; | 
|  | struct list_head nontrans_list; | 
|  |  | 
|  | s32 signal; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u16 beacon_interval; | 
|  | u16 capability; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; | 
|  | u8 chains; | 
|  | s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 bssid_index; | 
|  | u8 max_bssid_indicator; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID | 
|  | * @bss: the bss to search | 
|  | * @id: the element ID | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so | 
|  | * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. | 
|  | * Return: %NULL if not found. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID | 
|  | * @bss: the bss to search | 
|  | * @id: the element ID | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so | 
|  | * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. | 
|  | * Return: %NULL if not found. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 | 
|  | * authentication. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference | 
|  | *	to it if it needs to keep it. | 
|  | * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) | 
|  | * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL | 
|  | * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets | 
|  | * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication | 
|  | * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication | 
|  | * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication | 
|  | * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains | 
|  | *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the | 
|  | *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication | 
|  | *	transaction sequence number field. | 
|  | * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets | 
|  | * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD, | 
|  | *	the interface address is included as the MLD address and the | 
|  | *	necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and | 
|  | *	given an MLD address) by the driver | 
|  | * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with | 
|  | *	an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0 | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_auth_request { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss *bss; | 
|  | const u8 *ie; | 
|  | size_t ie_len; | 
|  | enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; | 
|  | const u8 *key; | 
|  | u8 key_len; | 
|  | s8 key_idx; | 
|  | const u8 *auth_data; | 
|  | size_t auth_data_len; | 
|  | s8 link_id; | 
|  | const u8 *ap_mld_addr; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association | 
|  | * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss; | 
|  | *	if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested | 
|  | * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link | 
|  | * @elems_len: length of the elements | 
|  | * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it | 
|  | *	should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_assoc_link { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss *bss; | 
|  | const u8 *elems; | 
|  | size_t elems_len; | 
|  | bool disabled; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n) | 
|  | * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT | 
|  | * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association | 
|  | * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external | 
|  | *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to | 
|  | *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect() | 
|  | *	request (connect callback). | 
|  | * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE:  Disable HE | 
|  | * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT:  Disable EHT | 
|  | * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links. | 
|  | *	Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this | 
|  | *	flag is not set. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags { | 
|  | ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0), | 
|  | ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1), | 
|  | ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2), | 
|  | CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3), | 
|  | ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE			= BIT(4), | 
|  | ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT			= BIT(5), | 
|  | CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT			= BIT(6), | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 | 
|  | * (re)association. | 
|  | * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is | 
|  | *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc() | 
|  | *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new | 
|  | *	association requests while already associating must be rejected. | 
|  | *	This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead | 
|  | *	of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations. | 
|  | * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL | 
|  | * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets | 
|  | * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association | 
|  | * @crypto: crypto settings | 
|  | * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used | 
|  | *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request | 
|  | *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to | 
|  | *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is | 
|  | *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request | 
|  | *	frame. | 
|  | * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags | 
|  | * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask | 
|  | *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored. | 
|  | * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. | 
|  | * @vht_capa: VHT capability override | 
|  | * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use | 
|  | * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or | 
|  | *	%NULL if FILS is not used. | 
|  | * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets | 
|  | * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association | 
|  | *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts | 
|  | *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. | 
|  | * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override | 
|  | * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask | 
|  | * @links: per-link information for MLO connections | 
|  | * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates | 
|  | *	the link on which the association request should be sent | 
|  | * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request, | 
|  | *	valid iff @link_id >= 0 | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_assoc_request { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss *bss; | 
|  | const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid; | 
|  | size_t ie_len; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; | 
|  | bool use_mfp; | 
|  | u32 flags; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask; | 
|  | const u8 *fils_kek; | 
|  | size_t fils_kek_len; | 
|  | const u8 *fils_nonces; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | 
|  | const u8 *ap_mld_addr; | 
|  | s8 link_id; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 | 
|  | * deauthentication. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from | 
|  | * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL | 
|  | * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets | 
|  | * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication | 
|  | * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and | 
|  | *	do not set a deauth frame | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_deauth_request { | 
|  | const u8 *bssid; | 
|  | const u8 *ie; | 
|  | size_t ie_len; | 
|  | u16 reason_code; | 
|  | bool local_state_change; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 | 
|  | * disassociation. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from | 
|  | * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL | 
|  | * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets | 
|  | * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation | 
|  | * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no | 
|  | *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_disassoc_request { | 
|  | const u8 *ap_addr; | 
|  | const u8 *ie; | 
|  | size_t ie_len; | 
|  | u16 reason_code; | 
|  | bool local_state_change; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss() | 
|  | * method. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null. | 
|  | * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero. | 
|  | * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not | 
|  | *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID. | 
|  | * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found | 
|  | * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for | 
|  | *	IBSSs to join on other channels. | 
|  | * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon | 
|  | * @ie_len: length of that | 
|  | * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use | 
|  | * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured | 
|  | *	after joining | 
|  | * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., | 
|  | *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is | 
|  | *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by | 
|  | *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. | 
|  | * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control | 
|  | *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. | 
|  | * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. | 
|  | *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required | 
|  | *	to operate on DFS channels. | 
|  | * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS | 
|  | * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) | 
|  | * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask | 
|  | *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored. | 
|  | * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. | 
|  | * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of | 
|  | *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys | 
|  | * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ibss_params { | 
|  | const u8 *ssid; | 
|  | const u8 *bssid; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | 
|  | const u8 *ie; | 
|  | u8 ssid_len, ie_len; | 
|  | u16 beacon_interval; | 
|  | u32 basic_rates; | 
|  | bool channel_fixed; | 
|  | bool privacy; | 
|  | bool control_port; | 
|  | bool control_port_over_nl80211; | 
|  | bool userspace_handles_dfs; | 
|  | int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; | 
|  | struct key_params *wep_keys; | 
|  | int wep_tx_key; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour. | 
|  | * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour. | 
|  | * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF. | 
|  | * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss_selection { | 
|  | enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour; | 
|  | union { | 
|  | enum nl80211_band band_pref; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust; | 
|  | } param; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 | 
|  | * authentication and association. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based | 
|  | *	on scan results) | 
|  | * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or | 
|  | *	%NULL if not specified | 
|  | * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan | 
|  | *	results) | 
|  | * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or | 
|  | *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is | 
|  | *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS | 
|  | *	to use. | 
|  | * @ssid: SSID | 
|  | * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets | 
|  | * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) | 
|  | * @ie: IEs for association request | 
|  | * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets | 
|  | * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used | 
|  | * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used | 
|  | * @crypto: crypto settings | 
|  | * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication | 
|  | * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication | 
|  | * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication | 
|  | * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags | 
|  | * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds | 
|  | *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used. | 
|  | * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask | 
|  | *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored. | 
|  | * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. | 
|  | * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides | 
|  | * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used. | 
|  | * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG | 
|  | *	networks. | 
|  | * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection. | 
|  | * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used | 
|  | *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request | 
|  | *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to | 
|  | *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is | 
|  | *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request | 
|  | *	frame. | 
|  | * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the | 
|  | *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped | 
|  | *	data IE. | 
|  | * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets. | 
|  | * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or | 
|  | *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and | 
|  | *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. | 
|  | * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets. | 
|  | * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP | 
|  | *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. | 
|  | * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional | 
|  | *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified. | 
|  | * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets. | 
|  | * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver | 
|  | *	offload of 4-way handshake. | 
|  | * @edmg: define the EDMG channels. | 
|  | *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver | 
|  | *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_connect_params { | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *channel; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint; | 
|  | const u8 *bssid; | 
|  | const u8 *bssid_hint; | 
|  | const u8 *ssid; | 
|  | size_t ssid_len; | 
|  | enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; | 
|  | const u8 *ie; | 
|  | size_t ie_len; | 
|  | bool privacy; | 
|  | enum nl80211_mfp mfp; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; | 
|  | const u8 *key; | 
|  | u8 key_len, key_idx; | 
|  | u32 flags; | 
|  | int bg_scan_period; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask; | 
|  | bool pbss; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select; | 
|  | const u8 *prev_bssid; | 
|  | const u8 *fils_erp_username; | 
|  | size_t fils_erp_username_len; | 
|  | const u8 *fils_erp_realm; | 
|  | size_t fils_erp_realm_len; | 
|  | u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num; | 
|  | const u8 *fils_erp_rrk; | 
|  | size_t fils_erp_rrk_len; | 
|  | bool want_1x; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that | 
|  | * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated | 
|  | * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm, | 
|  | *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated | 
|  | * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed { | 
|  | UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0), | 
|  | UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1), | 
|  | UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2), | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values | 
|  | * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed | 
|  | * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed | 
|  | * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed | 
|  | * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed | 
|  | * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed | 
|  | * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled | 
|  | * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed | 
|  | * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed | 
|  | * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum wiphy_params_flags { | 
|  | WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= 1 << 0, | 
|  | WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= 1 << 1, | 
|  | WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 2, | 
|  | WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 3, | 
|  | WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= 1 << 4, | 
|  | WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= 1 << 5, | 
|  | WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= 1 << 6, | 
|  | WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= 1 << 7, | 
|  | WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= 1 << 8, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256 | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */ | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000 | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000 | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */ | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000 | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA | 
|  | * caching. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL). | 
|  | * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. | 
|  | * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key | 
|  | *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL. | 
|  | * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on | 
|  | *	the hash algorithm used to generate this. | 
|  | * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS | 
|  | *	cache identifier (may be %NULL). | 
|  | * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets. | 
|  | * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the | 
|  | *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be | 
|  | *	%NULL). | 
|  | * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds | 
|  | *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified. | 
|  | *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after | 
|  | *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on | 
|  | *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK | 
|  | *	used for it expires. | 
|  | * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of | 
|  | *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified. | 
|  | *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using | 
|  | *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this | 
|  | *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmksa { | 
|  | const u8 *bssid; | 
|  | const u8 *pmkid; | 
|  | const u8 *pmk; | 
|  | size_t pmk_len; | 
|  | const u8 *ssid; | 
|  | size_t ssid_len; | 
|  | const u8 *cache_id; | 
|  | u32 pmk_lifetime; | 
|  | u8 pmk_reauth_threshold; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern | 
|  | * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes, | 
|  | *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211 | 
|  | * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1 | 
|  | * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes) | 
|  | * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes) | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of | 
|  | * memory, free @mask only! | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern { | 
|  | const u8 *mask, *pattern; | 
|  | int pattern_len; | 
|  | int pkt_offset; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation | 
|  | * @src: source IP address | 
|  | * @dst: destination IP address | 
|  | * @dst_mac: destination MAC address | 
|  | * @src_port: source port | 
|  | * @dst_port: destination port | 
|  | * @payload_len: data payload length | 
|  | * @payload: data payload buffer | 
|  | * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration | 
|  | * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets | 
|  | * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length | 
|  | * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data | 
|  | * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask | 
|  | * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer | 
|  | * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp { | 
|  | struct socket *sock; | 
|  | __be32 src, dst; | 
|  | u16 src_port, dst_port; | 
|  | u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN]; | 
|  | int payload_len; | 
|  | const u8 *payload; | 
|  | struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq; | 
|  | u32 data_interval; | 
|  | u32 wake_len; | 
|  | const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask; | 
|  | u32 tokens_size; | 
|  | /* must be last, variable member */ | 
|  | struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device. | 
|  | * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues | 
|  | *	operating as normal during suspend | 
|  | * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected | 
|  | * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet | 
|  | * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern | 
|  | * @n_patterns: number of patterns | 
|  | * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure | 
|  | * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet | 
|  | * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake | 
|  | * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released | 
|  | * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h. | 
|  | *	NULL if not configured. | 
|  | * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_wowlan { | 
|  | bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, | 
|  | eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, | 
|  | rfkill_release; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp; | 
|  | int n_patterns; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device. | 
|  | * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs. | 
|  | * @condition: condition for packet coalescence. | 
|  | *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. | 
|  | * @patterns: array of packet patterns | 
|  | * @n_patterns: number of patterns | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules { | 
|  | int delay; | 
|  | enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; | 
|  | int n_patterns; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure defines coalescing settings. | 
|  | * @rules: array of coalesce rules | 
|  | * @n_rules: number of rules | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_coalesce { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules; | 
|  | int n_rules; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up | 
|  | * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This | 
|  | *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels. | 
|  | * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match | 
|  | *	occurred (in MHz) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; | 
|  | int n_channels; | 
|  | u32 channels[]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in | 
|  | *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide | 
|  | *	match information. | 
|  | * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about | 
|  | *	the matches that triggered the wake up. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info { | 
|  | int n_matches; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report | 
|  | * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected | 
|  | * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet | 
|  | * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure | 
|  | * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet | 
|  | * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake | 
|  | * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released | 
|  | * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern | 
|  | * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data | 
|  | * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length | 
|  | * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any. | 
|  | * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data | 
|  | *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for | 
|  | *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which | 
|  | *	it is. | 
|  | * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received | 
|  | * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish | 
|  | * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens | 
|  | * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup { | 
|  | bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, | 
|  | eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, | 
|  | rfkill_release, packet_80211, | 
|  | tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens; | 
|  | s32 pattern_idx; | 
|  | u32 packet_present_len, packet_len; | 
|  | const void *packet; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data | 
|  | * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes) | 
|  | * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes) | 
|  | * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes) | 
|  | * @kek_len: length of kek | 
|  | * @kck_len: length of kck | 
|  | * @akm: akm (oui, id) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data { | 
|  | const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr; | 
|  | u32 akm; | 
|  | u8 kek_len, kck_len; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value | 
|  | * @ie: Fast Transition IEs | 
|  | * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params { | 
|  | u16 md; | 
|  | const u8 *ie; | 
|  | size_t ie_len; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @chan: channel to use | 
|  | * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required | 
|  | * @wait: duration for ROC | 
|  | * @buf: buffer to transmit | 
|  | * @len: buffer length | 
|  | * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame | 
|  | * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack | 
|  | * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array | 
|  | * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame | 
|  | * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note | 
|  | *	that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the | 
|  | *	link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params { | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *chan; | 
|  | bool offchan; | 
|  | unsigned int wait; | 
|  | const u8 *buf; | 
|  | size_t len; | 
|  | bool no_cck; | 
|  | bool dont_wait_for_ack; | 
|  | int n_csa_offsets; | 
|  | const u16 *csa_offsets; | 
|  | int link_id; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition | 
|  | * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_dscp_exception { | 
|  | u8 dscp; | 
|  | u8 up; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive | 
|  | * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_dscp_range { | 
|  | u8 low; | 
|  | u8 high; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */ | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21 | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16 | 
|  | #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \ | 
|  | (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21) | 
|  | * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from | 
|  | *	the user priority DSCP range definition | 
|  | * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_qos_map { | 
|  | u8 num_des; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX]; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255) | 
|  | * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. | 
|  | *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set | 
|  | *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_nan_conf { | 
|  | u8 master_pref; | 
|  | u8 bands; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN | 
|  | * configuration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference | 
|  | * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes { | 
|  | CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0), | 
|  | CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1), | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @filter: the content of the filter | 
|  | * @len: the length of the filter | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter { | 
|  | const u8 *filter; | 
|  | u8 len; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type | 
|  | * @service_id: the service ID of the function | 
|  | * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type | 
|  | * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is | 
|  | *	implementation specific. | 
|  | * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted | 
|  | * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active | 
|  | * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up | 
|  | * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up | 
|  | * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up | 
|  | * @ttl: time to live counter in DW. | 
|  | * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info | 
|  | * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length | 
|  | * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive | 
|  | * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter | 
|  | * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length | 
|  | * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index | 
|  | * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses | 
|  | * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF | 
|  | * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter | 
|  | * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF. | 
|  | * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters. | 
|  | * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters. | 
|  | * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function. | 
|  | * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_nan_func { | 
|  | enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; | 
|  | u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN]; | 
|  | u8 publish_type; | 
|  | bool close_range; | 
|  | bool publish_bcast; | 
|  | bool subscribe_active; | 
|  | u8 followup_id; | 
|  | u8 followup_reqid; | 
|  | struct mac_address followup_dest; | 
|  | u32 ttl; | 
|  | const u8 *serv_spec_info; | 
|  | u8 serv_spec_info_len; | 
|  | bool srf_include; | 
|  | const u8 *srf_bf; | 
|  | u8 srf_bf_len; | 
|  | u8 srf_bf_idx; | 
|  | struct mac_address *srf_macs; | 
|  | int srf_num_macs; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters; | 
|  | u8 num_tx_filters; | 
|  | u8 num_rx_filters; | 
|  | u8 instance_id; | 
|  | u64 cookie; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @aa: authenticator address | 
|  | * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes. | 
|  | * @pmk: the PMK material | 
|  | * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK | 
|  | *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field | 
|  | *	holds PMK-R0. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmk_conf { | 
|  | const u8 *aa; | 
|  | u8 pmk_len; | 
|  | const u8 *pmk; | 
|  | const u8 *pmk_r0_name; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant | 
|  | *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space). | 
|  | * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has | 
|  | *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and | 
|  | *	authentication response command interface. | 
|  | * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and | 
|  | *	authentication response command interface. | 
|  | * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the | 
|  | *	authentication request event interface. | 
|  | * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication, | 
|  | *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you | 
|  | *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication | 
|  | *	response command interface (user space to driver). | 
|  | * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. | 
|  | * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event | 
|  | *	interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication | 
|  | *	offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT | 
|  | *	flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space | 
|  | *	supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload. | 
|  | *	User space should use the address of the interface (on which the | 
|  | *	authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space | 
|  | *	and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of | 
|  | *	authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver | 
|  | *	translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link | 
|  | *	chosen for the authentication. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_external_auth_params { | 
|  | enum nl80211_external_auth_action action; | 
|  | u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; | 
|  | unsigned int key_mgmt_suite; | 
|  | u16 status; | 
|  | const u8 *pmkid; | 
|  | u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to | 
|  | *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them | 
|  | * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully | 
|  | *	answered | 
|  | * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were | 
|  | *	successfully answered | 
|  | * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions | 
|  | * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions | 
|  | * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions | 
|  | * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication | 
|  | *	of how much time the responder was busy | 
|  | * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from | 
|  | *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with | 
|  | *	the responder | 
|  | * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks | 
|  | *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot | 
|  | * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats { | 
|  | u32 filled; | 
|  | u32 success_num; | 
|  | u32 partial_num; | 
|  | u32 failed_num; | 
|  | u32 asap_num; | 
|  | u32 non_asap_num; | 
|  | u64 total_duration_ms; | 
|  | u32 unknown_triggers_num; | 
|  | u32 reschedule_requests_num; | 
|  | u32 out_of_window_triggers_num; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result | 
|  | * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is | 
|  | *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise | 
|  | *	reason than just "failure" | 
|  | * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index | 
|  | *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported | 
|  | * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted | 
|  | * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked | 
|  | * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, | 
|  | *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible | 
|  | *	by the responder | 
|  | * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated | 
|  | * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated | 
|  | * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated | 
|  | * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present) | 
|  | * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present) | 
|  | * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL) | 
|  | * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL) | 
|  | * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported | 
|  | * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported | 
|  | * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response | 
|  | * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame | 
|  | * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg) | 
|  | * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is | 
|  | *	the square root of the variance) | 
|  | * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured | 
|  | * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured | 
|  | *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg) | 
|  | * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance) | 
|  | * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread) | 
|  | * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid | 
|  | * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid | 
|  | * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid | 
|  | * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid | 
|  | * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid | 
|  | * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid | 
|  | * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid | 
|  | * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid | 
|  | * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid | 
|  | * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid | 
|  | * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid | 
|  | * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result { | 
|  | const u8 *lci; | 
|  | const u8 *civicloc; | 
|  | unsigned int lci_len; | 
|  | unsigned int civicloc_len; | 
|  | enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason; | 
|  | u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes; | 
|  | s16 burst_index; | 
|  | u8 busy_retry_time; | 
|  | u8 num_bursts_exp; | 
|  | u8 burst_duration; | 
|  | u8 ftms_per_burst; | 
|  | s32 rssi_avg; | 
|  | s32 rssi_spread; | 
|  | struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate; | 
|  | s64 rtt_avg; | 
|  | s64 rtt_variance; | 
|  | s64 rtt_spread; | 
|  | s64 dist_avg; | 
|  | s64 dist_variance; | 
|  | s64 dist_spread; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1, | 
|  | num_ftmr_successes_valid:1, | 
|  | rssi_avg_valid:1, | 
|  | rssi_spread_valid:1, | 
|  | tx_rate_valid:1, | 
|  | rx_rate_valid:1, | 
|  | rtt_avg_valid:1, | 
|  | rtt_variance_valid:1, | 
|  | rtt_spread_valid:1, | 
|  | dist_avg_valid:1, | 
|  | dist_variance_valid:1, | 
|  | dist_spread_valid:1; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result | 
|  | * @addr: address of the peer | 
|  | * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the | 
|  | *	measurement was made) | 
|  | * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time | 
|  | * @status: status of the measurement | 
|  | * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not | 
|  | *	reporting partial results always set this flag | 
|  | * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid | 
|  | * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting | 
|  | *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and | 
|  | *	they're all aggregated for userspace. | 
|  | * @ftm: FTM result | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_result { | 
|  | u64 host_time, ap_tsf; | 
|  | enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 final:1, | 
|  | ap_tsf_valid:1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type; | 
|  |  | 
|  | union { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm; | 
|  | }; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data | 
|  | * @requested: indicates FTM is requested | 
|  | * @preamble: frame preamble to use | 
|  | * @burst_period: burst period to use | 
|  | * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode | 
|  | * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent | 
|  | * @burst_duration: burst duration | 
|  | * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst | 
|  | * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request | 
|  | * @request_lci: request LCI information | 
|  | * @request_civicloc: request civic location information | 
|  | * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement | 
|  | *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, | 
|  | *		 EDCA based ranging will be used. | 
|  | * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement | 
|  | *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, | 
|  | *		 EDCA based ranging will be used. | 
|  | * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either | 
|  | *		 @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set. | 
|  | * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to | 
|  | *	indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if | 
|  | *	@non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer { | 
|  | enum nl80211_preamble preamble; | 
|  | u16 burst_period; | 
|  | u8 requested:1, | 
|  | asap:1, | 
|  | request_lci:1, | 
|  | request_civicloc:1, | 
|  | trigger_based:1, | 
|  | non_trigger_based:1, | 
|  | lmr_feedback:1; | 
|  | u8 num_bursts_exp; | 
|  | u8 burst_duration; | 
|  | u8 ftms_per_burst; | 
|  | u8 ftmr_retries; | 
|  | u8 bss_color; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request | 
|  | * @addr: MAC address | 
|  | * @chandef: channel to use | 
|  | * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF | 
|  | * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer { | 
|  | u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | 
|  | u8 report_ap_tsf:1; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request | 
|  | * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211 | 
|  | * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211 | 
|  | * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting, | 
|  | *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211 | 
|  | * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request | 
|  | * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that | 
|  | *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should | 
|  | *	be taken from the @mac_addr | 
|  | * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request | 
|  | * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if | 
|  | *	zero it means there's no timeout | 
|  | * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with | 
|  | * @peers: per-peer measurement request data | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request { | 
|  | u64 cookie; | 
|  | void *drv_data; | 
|  | u32 n_peers; | 
|  | u32 nl_portid; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 timeout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct list_head list; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE | 
|  | * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing | 
|  | *	has to be done. | 
|  | * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info | 
|  | *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space | 
|  | *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for | 
|  | *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver). | 
|  | * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are | 
|  | *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and | 
|  | *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface. | 
|  | * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets. | 
|  | * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested | 
|  | *	by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station | 
|  | *	connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it | 
|  | *	will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space). | 
|  | * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO | 
|  | *	connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when | 
|  | *	@assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only | 
|  | *	with OWE update event (driver to user space). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_update_owe_info { | 
|  | u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | u16 status; | 
|  | const u8 *ie; | 
|  | size_t ie_len; | 
|  | int assoc_link_id; | 
|  | u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data | 
|  | * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered | 
|  | *	for the entire device | 
|  | * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered | 
|  | *	for the given interface | 
|  | * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes | 
|  | * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface | 
|  | *	for these subtypes | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct mgmt_frame_regs { | 
|  | u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes; | 
|  | u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks | 
|  | * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0 | 
|  | * on success or a negative error code. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be | 
|  | * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied | 
|  | * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering, | 
|  | * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will | 
|  | *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are | 
|  | *	configured for the device. | 
|  | * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed | 
|  | * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback | 
|  | *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from | 
|  | *	the device. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name, | 
|  | *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create | 
|  | *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct | 
|  | *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must | 
|  | *	also set the address member in the wdev. | 
|  | *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface | 
|  | *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface, | 
|  | *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated. | 
|  | *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that | 
|  | *	the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link | 
|  | *	address is available. | 
|  | * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL | 
|  | *	when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. | 
|  | *	For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for | 
|  | *	pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters. | 
|  | *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group | 
|  | *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid | 
|  | *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is | 
|  | *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist. | 
|  | *	@link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, | 
|  | *	@link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr | 
|  | *	will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key) | 
|  | *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will | 
|  | *	be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 | 
|  | *	for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD | 
|  | *	address for MLO pairwise key. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0 | 
|  | *	for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface. | 
|  | *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface. | 
|  | *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters. | 
|  | * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode | 
|  | *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started. | 
|  | * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @add_station: Add a new station. | 
|  | * @del_station: Remove a station | 
|  | * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much | 
|  | *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags | 
|  | *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check | 
|  | *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call | 
|  | *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information. | 
|  | * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac | 
|  | * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path | 
|  | * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path | 
|  | * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path | 
|  | * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters | 
|  | * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx | 
|  | * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters | 
|  | * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx | 
|  | * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters | 
|  | *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network | 
|  | *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh. | 
|  | *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to | 
|  | *	set, and which to leave alone. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data | 
|  | *	for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called | 
|  | *	from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock. | 
|  | *	The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside | 
|  | *	struct cfg80211_inform_bss. | 
|  | *	The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas, | 
|  | *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to | 
|  | *	join the mesh instead. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other | 
|  | *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration. | 
|  | *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should | 
|  | *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given | 
|  | *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done(). | 
|  | *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside | 
|  | *	the scan/scan_done bracket too. | 
|  | * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall | 
|  | *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done(). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer | 
|  | *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer | 
|  | *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer | 
|  | *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer | 
|  | *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected, | 
|  | *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code | 
|  | *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call | 
|  | *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code | 
|  | *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code | 
|  | *	was received. | 
|  | *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the | 
|  | *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated | 
|  | *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches | 
|  | *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request | 
|  | *	frame instead of Association Request frame. | 
|  | *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a | 
|  | *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid | 
|  | *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an | 
|  | *	indication of requesting reassociation. | 
|  | *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming | 
|  | *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to | 
|  | *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a | 
|  | *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for | 
|  | *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the | 
|  | *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not | 
|  | *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current | 
|  | *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in | 
|  | *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed. | 
|  | *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if | 
|  | *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in | 
|  | *      case connection was already established (invoked with the | 
|  | *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout(). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call | 
|  | *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due | 
|  | *	to a merge. | 
|  | *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS. | 
|  | *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or | 
|  | *	MESH mode) | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed; | 
|  | *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values | 
|  | *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in | 
|  | *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters, | 
|  | *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The | 
|  | *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will | 
|  | *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power | 
|  | *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.) | 
|  | * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable; | 
|  | *	return 0 if successful | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting | 
|  | *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dump_survey: get site survey information. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified | 
|  | *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel | 
|  | *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is | 
|  | *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event | 
|  | *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel(). | 
|  | * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation. | 
|  | *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on | 
|  | *	the duration value. | 
|  | * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame. | 
|  | * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management | 
|  | *	frame on another channel | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL | 
|  | * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be | 
|  | *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally, | 
|  | *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the | 
|  | *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data | 
|  | *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present | 
|  | *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac | 
|  | *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association | 
|  | *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs. | 
|  | * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID. | 
|  | * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs. | 
|  | * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1 | 
|  | *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value. | 
|  | * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold. | 
|  | *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating | 
|  | *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may | 
|  | *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being | 
|  | *	disabled.) | 
|  | * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the | 
|  | *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the | 
|  | *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should | 
|  | *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented. | 
|  | *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config. | 
|  | * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error | 
|  | *	thresholds. | 
|  | * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan. | 
|  | * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with | 
|  | *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready | 
|  | *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be | 
|  | *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case. | 
|  | *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested | 
|  | *	stop (when this method returns 0). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame | 
|  | *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. | 
|  | *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may | 
|  | *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL | 
|  | *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame. | 
|  | * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it | 
|  | *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status(). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface. | 
|  | *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single | 
|  | *	current monitoring channel. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device. | 
|  | * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode. | 
|  | *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations | 
|  | *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver | 
|  | *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL | 
|  | *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which | 
|  | *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC | 
|  | *	was finished on another phy. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the | 
|  | *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be | 
|  | *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability | 
|  | *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the | 
|  | *	driver can take the most appropriate actions. | 
|  | * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link | 
|  | *	reliability. This operation can not fail. | 
|  | * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is | 
|  | *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is | 
|  | *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later | 
|  | *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept | 
|  | *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them | 
|  | *	as soon as possible. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the | 
|  | *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width | 
|  | *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device | 
|  | *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by | 
|  | *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into | 
|  | *	account. | 
|  | *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure | 
|  | *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return | 
|  | *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake | 
|  | *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later | 
|  | *	rejected) | 
|  | * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters | 
|  | *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network | 
|  | *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver | 
|  | *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations | 
|  | *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. | 
|  | * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both | 
|  | *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. | 
|  | * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface. | 
|  | * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface. | 
|  | * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure. | 
|  | *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and | 
|  | *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver | 
|  | *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling | 
|  | *	cfg80211_free_nan_func(). | 
|  | *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the | 
|  | *	provided @nan_func. | 
|  | * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function. | 
|  | * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must | 
|  | *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes); | 
|  | *	All other parameters must be ignored. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this | 
|  | *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake. | 
|  | *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect | 
|  | *	upon which the driver should clear it. | 
|  | *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator. | 
|  | *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from | 
|  | *     user space | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter | 
|  | *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. | 
|  | *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. | 
|  | * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) | 
|  | * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME | 
|  | *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated | 
|  | *	DH IE through this interface. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame | 
|  | *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm. | 
|  | * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific | 
|  | *	This callback may sleep. | 
|  | * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the | 
|  | *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @color_change: Initiate a color change. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use | 
|  | *	those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association | 
|  | *	Response frame. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for | 
|  | *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit | 
|  | *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. | 
|  | *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime | 
|  | *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected | 
|  | *	radar channel. | 
|  | *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to | 
|  | *	disable background CAC/radar detection. | 
|  | * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station. | 
|  | * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station. | 
|  | * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ops { | 
|  | int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow); | 
|  | int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  | void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled); | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | const char *name, | 
|  | unsigned char name_assign_type, | 
|  | enum nl80211_iftype type, | 
|  | struct vif_params *params); | 
|  | int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev); | 
|  | int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | enum nl80211_iftype type, | 
|  | struct vif_params *params); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | unsigned int link_id); | 
|  | void	(*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | unsigned int link_id); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, | 
|  | int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, | 
|  | const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params); | 
|  | int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, | 
|  | int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, | 
|  | const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie, | 
|  | void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*)); | 
|  | int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, | 
|  | int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, | 
|  | const u8 *mac_addr); | 
|  | int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *netdev, int link_id, | 
|  | u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast); | 
|  | int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *netdev, int link_id, | 
|  | u8 key_index); | 
|  | int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *netdev, | 
|  | int link_id, | 
|  | u8 key_index); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings); | 
|  | int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info); | 
|  | int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | unsigned int link_id); | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *mac, | 
|  | struct station_parameters *params); | 
|  | int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct station_del_parameters *params); | 
|  | int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *mac, | 
|  | struct station_parameters *params); | 
|  | int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); | 
|  | int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); | 
|  | int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *dst); | 
|  | int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); | 
|  | int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo); | 
|  | int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, | 
|  | struct mpath_info *pinfo); | 
|  | int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo); | 
|  | int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, | 
|  | struct mpath_info *pinfo); | 
|  | int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct mesh_config *conf); | 
|  | int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, u32 mask, | 
|  | const struct mesh_config *nconf); | 
|  | int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const struct mesh_config *conf, | 
|  | const struct mesh_setup *setup); | 
|  | int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct ocb_setup *setup); | 
|  | int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct bss_parameters *params); | 
|  |  | 
|  | void	(*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss, | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_txq_params *params); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *chan); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_scan_request *request); | 
|  | void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_auth_request *req); | 
|  | int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req); | 
|  | int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req); | 
|  | int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme); | 
|  | int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme, | 
|  | u32 changed); | 
|  | int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | u16 reason_code); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params); | 
|  | int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm); | 
|  | int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | int *dbm); | 
|  |  | 
|  | void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE | 
|  | int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | void *data, int len); | 
|  | int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb, | 
|  | struct netlink_callback *cb, | 
|  | void *data, int len); | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | unsigned int link_id, | 
|  | const u8 *peer, | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, | 
|  | int idx, struct survey_info *info); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); | 
|  | int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); | 
|  | int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *chan, | 
|  | unsigned int duration, | 
|  | u64 *cookie); | 
|  | int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | u64 cookie); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params, | 
|  | u64 *cookie); | 
|  | int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | u64 cookie); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | bool enabled, int timeout); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl); | 
|  |  | 
|  | void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); | 
|  | int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request); | 
|  | int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | u64 reqid); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *peer, int link_id, | 
|  | u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code, | 
|  | u32 peer_capability, bool initiator, | 
|  | const u8 *buf, size_t len); | 
|  | int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | u16 noack_map); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | unsigned int link_id, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev); | 
|  | void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | u32 cac_time_ms); | 
|  | void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev); | 
|  | int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie); | 
|  | int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol, | 
|  | u16 duration); | 
|  | void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev); | 
|  | int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | unsigned int link_id, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio, | 
|  | u16 admitted_time); | 
|  | int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | u8 tsid, const u8 *peer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | 
|  | void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *addr); | 
|  | int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); | 
|  | void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); | 
|  | int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); | 
|  | void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | u64 cookie); | 
|  | int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, | 
|  | u32 changes); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const bool enabled); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf); | 
|  | int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *aa); | 
|  | int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *buf, size_t len, | 
|  | const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto, | 
|  | const bool noencrypt, int link_id, | 
|  | u64 *cookie); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); | 
|  | void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); | 
|  | int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info); | 
|  | int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *buf, size_t len); | 
|  | int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); | 
|  | int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *peer, u8 tids); | 
|  | int	(*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); | 
|  | int	(*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params); | 
|  | int     (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad); | 
|  | int	(*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | 
|  | int	(*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct link_station_parameters *params); | 
|  | int	(*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct link_station_parameters *params); | 
|  | int	(*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct link_station_del_parameters *params); | 
|  | int	(*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* | 
|  | * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures | 
|  | * and registration/helper functions | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split | 
|  | *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this | 
|  | *	wiphy at all | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled | 
|  | *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default | 
|  | *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good | 
|  | *	reason to override the default | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station | 
|  | *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of | 
|  | *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the | 
|  | *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the | 
|  | *	control_port_no_encrypt flag. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing | 
|  | *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the | 
|  | *	firmware. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z) | 
|  | *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and | 
|  | *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT | 
|  | *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be | 
|  | *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes | 
|  | *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling | 
|  | *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(). | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device | 
|  | *	responds to probe-requests in hardware. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in | 
|  | *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...). | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs, | 
|  | *	in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have | 
|  | *	complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver | 
|  | *	should set this flag for now. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for | 
|  | *	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER. | 
|  | * @WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT: disable wireless extensions for this device | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum wiphy_flags { | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO			= BIT(1), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT			= BIT(9), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32          = BIT(11), | 
|  | /* use hole at 12 */ | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23), | 
|  | WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER	= BIT(24), | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types | 
|  | * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types | 
|  | * @types: interface types (bits) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_iface_limit { | 
|  | u16 max; | 
|  | u16 types; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination | 
|  | * | 
|  | * With this structure the driver can describe which interface | 
|  | * combinations it supports concurrently. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Examples: | 
|  | * | 
|  | * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total: | 
|  | * | 
|  | *    .. code-block:: c | 
|  | * | 
|  | *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = { | 
|  | *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, | 
|  | *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), }, | 
|  | *	}; | 
|  | *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = { | 
|  | *		.limits = limits1, | 
|  | *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1), | 
|  | *		.max_interfaces = 2, | 
|  | *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true, | 
|  | *	}; | 
|  | * | 
|  | * | 
|  | * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total: | 
|  | * | 
|  | *    .. code-block:: c | 
|  | * | 
|  | *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = { | 
|  | *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) | | 
|  | *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), }, | 
|  | *	}; | 
|  | *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = { | 
|  | *		.limits = limits2, | 
|  | *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2), | 
|  | *		.max_interfaces = 8, | 
|  | *		.num_different_channels = 1, | 
|  | *	}; | 
|  | * | 
|  | * | 
|  | * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total. | 
|  | * | 
|  | *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections. | 
|  | * | 
|  | *    .. code-block:: c | 
|  | * | 
|  | *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = { | 
|  | *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, | 
|  | *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) | | 
|  | *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), }, | 
|  | *	}; | 
|  | *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = { | 
|  | *		.limits = limits3, | 
|  | *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3), | 
|  | *		.max_interfaces = 4, | 
|  | *		.num_different_channels = 2, | 
|  | *	}; | 
|  | * | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_iface_combination { | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * @limits: | 
|  | * limits for the given interface types | 
|  | */ | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * @num_different_channels: | 
|  | * can use up to this many different channels | 
|  | */ | 
|  | u32 num_different_channels; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * @max_interfaces: | 
|  | * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group | 
|  | */ | 
|  | u16 max_interfaces; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * @n_limits: | 
|  | * number of limitations | 
|  | */ | 
|  | u8 n_limits; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * @beacon_int_infra_match: | 
|  | * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure | 
|  | * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool beacon_int_infra_match; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * @radar_detect_widths: | 
|  | * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection | 
|  | */ | 
|  | u8 radar_detect_widths; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * @radar_detect_regions: | 
|  | * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection | 
|  | */ | 
|  | u8 radar_detect_regions; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * @beacon_int_min_gcd: | 
|  | * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * = 0 | 
|  | *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same. | 
|  | * > 0 | 
|  | *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND | 
|  | *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this | 
|  | *   combination must be greater or equal to this value. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | u32 beacon_int_min_gcd; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes { | 
|  | u16 tx, rx; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags | 
|  | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any" | 
|  | *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and | 
|  | *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a | 
|  | *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the | 
|  | *	packet should be preserved in that case | 
|  | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet | 
|  | *	(see nl80211.h) | 
|  | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect | 
|  | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep | 
|  | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure | 
|  | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request | 
|  | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure | 
|  | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release | 
|  | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags { | 
|  | WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0), | 
|  | WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1), | 
|  | WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2), | 
|  | WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3), | 
|  | WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4), | 
|  | WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5), | 
|  | WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6), | 
|  | WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7), | 
|  | WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8), | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support { | 
|  | const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok; | 
|  | u32 data_payload_max; | 
|  | u32 data_interval_max; | 
|  | u32 wake_payload_max; | 
|  | bool seq; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data | 
|  | * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags | 
|  | * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns | 
|  | *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) | 
|  | * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern | 
|  | * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern | 
|  | * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset | 
|  | * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect, | 
|  | *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for | 
|  | *	scheduled scans. | 
|  | *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more | 
|  | *	details. | 
|  | * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct wiphy_wowlan_support { | 
|  | u32 flags; | 
|  | int n_patterns; | 
|  | int pattern_max_len; | 
|  | int pattern_min_len; | 
|  | int max_pkt_offset; | 
|  | int max_nd_match_sets; | 
|  | const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data | 
|  | * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules | 
|  | * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs | 
|  | * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule | 
|  | *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) | 
|  | * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern | 
|  | * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern | 
|  | * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct wiphy_coalesce_support { | 
|  | int n_rules; | 
|  | int max_delay; | 
|  | int n_patterns; | 
|  | int pattern_max_len; | 
|  | int pattern_min_len; | 
|  | int max_pkt_offset; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands | 
|  | * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev | 
|  | * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev | 
|  | * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running | 
|  | *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags { | 
|  | WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0), | 
|  | WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1), | 
|  | WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2), | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed | 
|  | * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed | 
|  | * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed | 
|  | * | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum wiphy_opmode_flag { | 
|  | STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0), | 
|  | STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1), | 
|  | STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2), | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information | 
|  | * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag | 
|  | * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station | 
|  | * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station | 
|  | * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct sta_opmode_info { | 
|  | u32 changed; | 
|  | enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; | 
|  | enum nl80211_chan_width bw; | 
|  | u8 rx_nss; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA)) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition | 
|  | * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211 | 
|  | * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags | 
|  | * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the | 
|  | *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data | 
|  | *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all | 
|  | * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The | 
|  | *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple | 
|  | *	dumpit calls. | 
|  | * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. | 
|  | *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the | 
|  | *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command). | 
|  | * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy | 
|  | * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and | 
|  | * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others | 
|  | * are used with dump requests. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct wiphy_vendor_command { | 
|  | struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info; | 
|  | u32 flags; | 
|  | int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | const void *data, int data_len); | 
|  | int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len, | 
|  | unsigned long *storage); | 
|  | const struct nla_policy *policy; | 
|  | unsigned int maxattr; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type | 
|  | * @iftype: interface type | 
|  | * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, | 
|  | *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the | 
|  | *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are | 
|  | *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std | 
|  | *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. | 
|  | * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values | 
|  | * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities | 
|  | * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO) | 
|  | * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab { | 
|  | enum nl80211_iftype iftype; | 
|  | const u8 *extended_capabilities; | 
|  | const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask; | 
|  | u8 extended_capabilities_len; | 
|  | u16 eml_capabilities; | 
|  | u16 mld_capa_and_ops; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from | 
|  | * @type: the interface type to look up | 
|  | */ | 
|  | const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab * | 
|  | cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities | 
|  | * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement | 
|  | * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement | 
|  | * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement | 
|  | * @ftm: FTM measurement data | 
|  | * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported | 
|  | * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported | 
|  | * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported | 
|  | * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data | 
|  | * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data | 
|  | * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble) | 
|  | * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width) | 
|  | * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported | 
|  | *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily | 
|  | *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick) | 
|  | * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if | 
|  | *	not limited) | 
|  | * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported | 
|  | * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities { | 
|  | unsigned int max_peers; | 
|  | u8 report_ap_tsf:1, | 
|  | randomize_mac_addr:1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | u32 preambles; | 
|  | u32 bandwidths; | 
|  | s8 max_bursts_exponent; | 
|  | u8 max_ftms_per_burst; | 
|  | u8 supported:1, | 
|  | asap:1, | 
|  | non_asap:1, | 
|  | request_lci:1, | 
|  | request_civicloc:1, | 
|  | trigger_based:1, | 
|  | non_trigger_based:1; | 
|  | } ftm; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm | 
|  | * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the | 
|  | * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types | 
|  | * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites | 
|  | * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites { | 
|  | u16 iftypes_mask; | 
|  | const u32 *akm_suites; | 
|  | int n_akm_suites; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS	0xffff | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description | 
|  | * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device | 
|  | * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback, | 
|  | *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory() | 
|  | *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL | 
|  | * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via | 
|  | *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver | 
|  | *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future | 
|  | *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers. | 
|  | * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss. | 
|  | * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites | 
|  | * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites | 
|  | * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if | 
|  | *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in | 
|  | *	iftype_akm_suites. | 
|  | * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites | 
|  | * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type. | 
|  | *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot | 
|  | *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all | 
|  | *	instances of iftype_akm_suites). | 
|  | * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm | 
|  | *	suites are specified separately. | 
|  | * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit) | 
|  | * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit) | 
|  | * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold); | 
|  | *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used | 
|  | * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled | 
|  | * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in | 
|  | * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device | 
|  | * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking, | 
|  | *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last | 
|  | *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual | 
|  | *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with | 
|  | *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up. | 
|  | * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses. | 
|  | * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer | 
|  | *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used | 
|  | *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to | 
|  | *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle | 
|  | *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses. | 
|  | * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against | 
|  | *	unregister hardware | 
|  | * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>). | 
|  | *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames | 
|  | * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in | 
|  | *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev() | 
|  | *	(see below). | 
|  | * @wext: wireless extension handlers | 
|  | * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter) | 
|  | * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy, | 
|  | *	must be set by driver | 
|  | * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not | 
|  | *	list single interface types. | 
|  | * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array. | 
|  | * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not | 
|  | *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW. | 
|  | * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags | 
|  | * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see | 
|  | *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags | 
|  | * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags. | 
|  | * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see | 
|  | *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index. | 
|  | * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it, | 
|  | *	this variable determines its size | 
|  | * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in | 
|  | *	any given scan | 
|  | * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that | 
|  | *	the device can run concurrently. | 
|  | * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan | 
|  | *	for in any given scheduled scan | 
|  | * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle | 
|  | *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not | 
|  | *	supported. | 
|  | * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can | 
|  | *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not | 
|  | *	include fixed IEs like supported rates | 
|  | * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled | 
|  | *	scans | 
|  | * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number | 
|  | *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device. | 
|  | * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a | 
|  | *	single scan plan supported by the device. | 
|  | * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single | 
|  | *	scan plan supported by the device. | 
|  | * @coverage_class: current coverage class | 
|  | * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting | 
|  | * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting | 
|  | * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device | 
|  | * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary | 
|  | *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers | 
|  | * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or | 
|  | *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface | 
|  | *	type | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be | 
|  | *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be | 
|  | *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be | 
|  | *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be | 
|  | *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @probe_resp_offload: | 
|  | *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading. | 
|  | *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid | 
|  | *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation | 
|  | *	may request, if implemented. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information | 
|  | * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be | 
|  | *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed | 
|  | *	to the suspend() operation instead. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. | 
|  | * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden. | 
|  | *	If null, then none can be over-ridden. | 
|  | * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden. | 
|  | *	If null, then none can be over-ridden. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must | 
|  | *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device | 
|  | *	supports for ACL. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, | 
|  | *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are | 
|  | *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") | 
|  | *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See | 
|  | *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default | 
|  | *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified | 
|  | *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab. | 
|  | * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values | 
|  | * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities | 
|  | * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type | 
|  | * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended | 
|  | *	capabilities are specified separately. | 
|  | * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware | 
|  | * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands | 
|  | * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware | 
|  | * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode | 
|  | *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The | 
|  | *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in | 
|  | *	some cases, but may not always reach. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons | 
|  | *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver | 
|  | *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means | 
|  | *	infinite. | 
|  | * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported | 
|  | *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the | 
|  | *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a | 
|  | *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for | 
|  | *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set | 
|  | *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit | 
|  | * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit | 
|  | * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using | 
|  | *	wake_tx_queue | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP | 
|  | * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not | 
|  | *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues. | 
|  | *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the | 
|  | *	device has | 
|  | * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations) | 
|  | *	supported by the driver for each vif | 
|  | * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations) | 
|  | *	supported by the driver for each peer | 
|  | * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for | 
|  | *	long/short retry configuration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for | 
|  | *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and | 
|  | *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes | 
|  | * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities | 
|  | * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver | 
|  | *	in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value | 
|  | *	by the driver to advertise MBSSID support. | 
|  | * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by | 
|  | *	the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the | 
|  | *	driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP). | 
|  | * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for | 
|  | *	configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and | 
|  | *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by | 
|  | *	driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is | 
|  | *	NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with | 
|  | *	legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is | 
|  | *	CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports | 
|  | *	enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a | 
|  | *	non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping. | 
|  | *	A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver | 
|  | *	supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to | 
|  | *	specify a mac address). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct wiphy { | 
|  | struct mutex mtx; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN]; | 
|  | u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct mac_address *addresses; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations; | 
|  | int n_iface_combinations; | 
|  | u16 software_iftypes; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u16 n_addresses; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */ | 
|  | u16 interface_modes; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u16 max_acl_mac_addrs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features; | 
|  | u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 ap_sme_capa; | 
|  |  | 
|  | enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type; | 
|  |  | 
|  | int bss_priv_size; | 
|  | u8 max_scan_ssids; | 
|  | u8 max_sched_scan_reqs; | 
|  | u8 max_sched_scan_ssids; | 
|  | u8 max_match_sets; | 
|  | u16 max_scan_ie_len; | 
|  | u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len; | 
|  | u32 max_sched_scan_plans; | 
|  | u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval; | 
|  | u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations; | 
|  |  | 
|  | int n_cipher_suites; | 
|  | const u32 *cipher_suites; | 
|  |  | 
|  | int n_akm_suites; | 
|  | const u32 *akm_suites; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites; | 
|  | unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 retry_short; | 
|  | u8 retry_long; | 
|  | u32 frag_threshold; | 
|  | u32 rts_threshold; | 
|  | u8 coverage_class; | 
|  |  | 
|  | char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN]; | 
|  | u32 hw_version; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifdef CONFIG_PM | 
|  | const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config; | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 max_num_pmkids; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 available_antennas_tx; | 
|  | u32 available_antennas_rx; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 probe_resp_offload; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask; | 
|  | u8 extended_capabilities_len; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab; | 
|  | unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const void *privid; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct regulatory_request *request); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct device dev; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool registered; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct dentry *debugfsdir; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct list_head wdev_list; | 
|  |  | 
|  | possible_net_t _net; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT | 
|  | const struct iw_handler_def *wext; | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands; | 
|  | const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events; | 
|  | int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u16 max_ap_assoc_sta; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 max_num_csa_counters; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 bss_select_support; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 nan_supported_bands; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 txq_limit; | 
|  | u32 txq_memory_limit; | 
|  | u32 txq_quantum; | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned long tx_queue_len; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 support_mbssid:1, | 
|  | support_only_he_mbssid:1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | u64 peer, vif; | 
|  | u8 max_retry; | 
|  | } tid_config_support; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 max_data_retry_count; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct rfkill *rfkill; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 mbssid_max_interfaces; | 
|  | u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity; | 
|  | u16 max_num_akm_suites; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers; | 
|  |  | 
|  | char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net) | 
|  | { | 
|  | write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return | 
|  | * Return: The priv of @wiphy. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy) | 
|  | { | 
|  | BUG_ON(!wiphy); | 
|  | return &wiphy->priv; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv | 
|  | * Return: The wiphy of @priv. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv) | 
|  | { | 
|  | BUG_ON(!priv); | 
|  | return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind | 
|  | * @dev: The device to parent it to | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev) | 
|  | { | 
|  | wiphy->dev.parent = dev; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up | 
|  | * Return: The dev of @wiphy. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return wiphy->dev.parent; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_name - get wiphy name | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return | 
|  | * Return: The name of @wiphy. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return dev_name(&wiphy->dev); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @ops: The configuration operations for this device | 
|  | * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate | 
|  | * @requested_name: Request a particular name. | 
|  | *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. | 
|  | * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be | 
|  | * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv, | 
|  | const char *requested_name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @ops: The configuration operations for this device | 
|  | * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. | 
|  | * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be | 
|  | * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, | 
|  | int sizeof_priv) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211 | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: The wiphy to register. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */ | 
|  | #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on | 
|  | * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock() | 
|  | * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference(). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p)				\ | 
|  | rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on | 
|  | * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the | 
|  | * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p)				\ | 
|  | rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from | 
|  | */ | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211 | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv | 
|  | * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding | 
|  | * request that is being handled. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_free - free wiphy | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: The wiphy to free | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* internal structs */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_conn; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_internal_bss; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_cached_keys; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_cqm_config; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that | 
|  | * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking | 
|  | * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot | 
|  | * differentiate which way it's called. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued | 
|  | * with wiphy_queue_work() are running. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy) | 
|  | __acquires(&wiphy->mtx) | 
|  | { | 
|  | mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx); | 
|  | __acquire(&wiphy->mtx); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy) | 
|  | __releases(&wiphy->mtx) | 
|  | { | 
|  | __release(&wiphy->mtx); | 
|  | mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct wiphy_work; | 
|  | typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *); | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct wiphy_work { | 
|  | struct list_head entry; | 
|  | wiphy_work_func_t func; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work, | 
|  | wiphy_work_func_t func) | 
|  | { | 
|  | INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry); | 
|  | work->func = func; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for | 
|  | * @work: the work item | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work | 
|  | * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be | 
|  | * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running | 
|  | * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can | 
|  | * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires | 
|  | * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock(). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes | 
|  | * @work: the work to cancel | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being | 
|  | * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes | 
|  | * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called | 
|  | * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct wiphy_delayed_work { | 
|  | struct wiphy_work work; | 
|  | struct wiphy *wiphy; | 
|  | struct timer_list timer; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork, | 
|  | wiphy_work_func_t func) | 
|  | { | 
|  | timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0); | 
|  | wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for | 
|  | * @dwork: the delayable worker | 
|  | * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work | 
|  | * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be | 
|  | * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running | 
|  | * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can | 
|  | * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires | 
|  | * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock(). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork, | 
|  | unsigned long delay); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes | 
|  | * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being | 
|  | * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes | 
|  | * @work: the work to flush | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called | 
|  | * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state | 
|  | * | 
|  | * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver | 
|  | * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this | 
|  | * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.) | 
|  | * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will | 
|  | * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device, | 
|  | * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or | 
|  | * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops | 
|  | * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.) | 
|  | * | 
|  | * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver | 
|  | * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as | 
|  | * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be | 
|  | * allocated outside of callback operations that return it. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description | 
|  | * @iftype: interface type | 
|  | * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211 | 
|  | * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock | 
|  | *	for the notifier | 
|  | * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces | 
|  | * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL | 
|  | * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this | 
|  | *	wireless device if it has no netdev | 
|  | * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype | 
|  | * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode) | 
|  | * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code | 
|  | * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code | 
|  | * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling | 
|  | * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data | 
|  | * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data | 
|  | * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association | 
|  | * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements | 
|  | * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID | 
|  | * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID | 
|  | * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index | 
|  | * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index | 
|  | * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation | 
|  | * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity | 
|  | * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be | 
|  | *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the | 
|  | *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update | 
|  | *	by cfg80211 on change_interface | 
|  | * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames | 
|  | * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated, | 
|  | *	need to propagate the update to the driver | 
|  | * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers | 
|  | *	and some API functions require it held | 
|  | * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting | 
|  | *	beacons, 0 when not valid | 
|  | * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL | 
|  | * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g. | 
|  | *	the P2P Device. | 
|  | * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started | 
|  | * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. | 
|  | * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms | 
|  | * @ps: powersave mode is enabled | 
|  | * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout | 
|  | * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application | 
|  | *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode) | 
|  | * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data | 
|  | * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established | 
|  | * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type | 
|  | * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID | 
|  | * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work | 
|  | * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect | 
|  | * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing | 
|  | * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list | 
|  | * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID | 
|  | * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away | 
|  | * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work | 
|  | * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state | 
|  | * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests | 
|  | * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock | 
|  | * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work | 
|  | * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last | 
|  | *	unprotected beacon report | 
|  | * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr | 
|  | *	@ap and @client for each link | 
|  | * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct wireless_dev { | 
|  | struct wiphy *wiphy; | 
|  | enum nl80211_iftype iftype; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */ | 
|  | struct list_head list; | 
|  | struct net_device *netdev; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 identifier; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct list_head mgmt_registrations; | 
|  | u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct mutex mtx; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_conn *conn; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys; | 
|  | enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type; | 
|  | u32 conn_owner_nlportid; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct work_struct disconnect_wk; | 
|  | u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct list_head event_list; | 
|  | spinlock_t event_lock; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u8 connected:1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool ps; | 
|  | int ps_timeout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u32 owner_nlportid; | 
|  | bool nl_owner_dead; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* FIXME: need to rework radar detection for MLO */ | 
|  | bool cac_started; | 
|  | unsigned long cac_start_time; | 
|  | unsigned int cac_time_ms; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT | 
|  | /* wext data */ | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_connect_params connect; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys; | 
|  | const u8 *ie; | 
|  | size_t ie_len; | 
|  | u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; | 
|  | u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; | 
|  | u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; | 
|  | s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key; | 
|  | bool prev_bssid_valid; | 
|  | } wext; | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct list_head pmsr_list; | 
|  | spinlock_t pmsr_lock; | 
|  | struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk; | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported; | 
|  |  | 
|  | union { | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; | 
|  | u8 ssid_len; | 
|  | } client; | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | int beacon_interval; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | 
|  | u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; | 
|  | u8 id_len, id_up_len; | 
|  | } mesh; | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; | 
|  | u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; | 
|  | u8 ssid_len; | 
|  | } ap; | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | 
|  | int beacon_interval; | 
|  | u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; | 
|  | u8 ssid_len; | 
|  | } ibss; | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | 
|  | } ocb; | 
|  | } u; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | union { | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | unsigned int beacon_interval; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | 
|  | } ap; | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; | 
|  | } client; | 
|  | }; | 
|  | } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | 
|  | u16 valid_links; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (wdev->netdev) | 
|  | return wdev->netdev->dev_addr; | 
|  | return wdev->address; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (wdev->netdev) | 
|  | return netif_running(wdev->netdev); | 
|  | return wdev->is_running; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return | 
|  | * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev) | 
|  | { | 
|  | BUG_ON(!wdev); | 
|  | return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev | 
|  | * @wdev: the wdev | 
|  | * @link_id: the link ID for MLO | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | unsigned int link_id); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | unsigned int link_id) | 
|  | { | 
|  | WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links); | 
|  | WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links && | 
|  | !(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id))); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id)			\ | 
|  | for (link_id = 0;					\ | 
|  | link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ?		\ | 
|  | ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1);	\ | 
|  | link_id++)						\ | 
|  | if (!(link_info)->valid_links ||		\ | 
|  | ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id))) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * DOC: Utility functions | 
|  | * | 
|  | * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful. | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel | 
|  | * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel | 
|  | * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline bool | 
|  | ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq && | 
|  | a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz | 
|  | * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert | 
|  | * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline u32 | 
|  | ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ | 
|  | * @chan: channel | 
|  | * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum nl80211_chan_width | 
|  | ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency | 
|  | * @chan: channel number | 
|  | * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap | 
|  | * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency | 
|  | * @chan: channel number | 
|  | * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap | 
|  | * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline int | 
|  | ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number | 
|  | * @freq: center frequency in KHz | 
|  | * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number | 
|  | * @freq: center frequency in MHz | 
|  | * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline int | 
|  | ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified | 
|  | * frequency | 
|  | * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for | 
|  | * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel | 
|  | * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel * | 
|  | ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for | 
|  | * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel | 
|  | * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline struct ieee80211_channel * | 
|  | ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC | 
|  | * @chan: control channel to check | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in | 
|  | * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3 | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @sband: the band to look for rates in | 
|  | * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates | 
|  | * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that | 
|  | * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map, | 
|  | * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of | 
|  | * rates in the band's bitrate table. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_rate * | 
|  | ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | 
|  | u32 basic_rates, int bitrate); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band | 
|  | * @sband: the band to look for rates in | 
|  | * @scan_width: width of the control channel | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given | 
|  | * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | 
|  | enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* | 
|  | * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c | 
|  | * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct radiotap_align_size { | 
|  | uint8_t align:4, size:4; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace { | 
|  | const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size; | 
|  | int n_bits; | 
|  | uint32_t oui; | 
|  | uint8_t subns; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces { | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns; | 
|  | int n_ns; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args | 
|  | * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call | 
|  | *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() | 
|  | * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each | 
|  | *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after | 
|  | *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to | 
|  | *	the beginning of the actual data portion | 
|  | * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience | 
|  | * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition | 
|  | *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown) | 
|  | * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default | 
|  | *	radiotap namespace or not | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through | 
|  | * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering | 
|  | * @_arg_index: next argument index | 
|  | * @_arg: next argument pointer | 
|  | * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32 | 
|  | * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present | 
|  | * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions | 
|  | * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data | 
|  | * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the | 
|  | *	next bitmap word | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore | 
|  | * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally. | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator { | 
|  | struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns; | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace; | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data; | 
|  | __le32 *_next_bitmap; | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned char *this_arg; | 
|  | int this_arg_index; | 
|  | int this_arg_size; | 
|  |  | 
|  | int is_radiotap_ns; | 
|  |  | 
|  | int _max_length; | 
|  | int _arg_index; | 
|  | uint32_t _bitmap_shifter; | 
|  | int _reset_on_ext; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header, | 
|  | int max_length, | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator); | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6]; | 
|  | extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @skb: the frame | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function | 
|  | * returns the 802.11 header length. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption | 
|  | * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid | 
|  | * 802.11 header. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control | 
|  | * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format | 
|  | * Return: The header length in bytes. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length | 
|  | * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field | 
|  | *	(first byte) will be accessed | 
|  | * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at | 
|  | * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * DOC: Data path helpers | 
|  | * | 
|  | * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers | 
|  | * functions that help implement the data path for devices | 
|  | * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device. | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 | 
|  | * @skb: the 802.11 data frame | 
|  | * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead | 
|  | *	of it being pushed into the SKB | 
|  | * @addr: the device MAC address | 
|  | * @iftype: the virtual interface type | 
|  | * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header | 
|  | * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU | 
|  | * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr, | 
|  | const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, | 
|  | u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 | 
|  | * @skb: the 802.11 data frame | 
|  | * @addr: the device MAC address | 
|  | * @iftype: the virtual interface type | 
|  | * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr, | 
|  | enum nl80211_iftype iftype) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated | 
|  | * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the | 
|  | * mesh control field. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. | 
|  | * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test | 
|  | *	0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field | 
|  | *	1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field | 
|  | *	2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field | 
|  | * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames. | 
|  | * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully | 
|  | * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. | 
|  | * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and | 
|  | *	initialized by the caller. | 
|  | * @addr: The device MAC address. | 
|  | * @iftype: The device interface type. | 
|  | * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list. | 
|  | * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL | 
|  | * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL | 
|  | * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list, | 
|  | const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, | 
|  | const unsigned int extra_headroom, | 
|  | const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa, | 
|  | u8 mesh_control); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated | 
|  | * protocol. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload | 
|  | * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol | 
|  | * Return: true if encapsulation was found | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part | 
|  | * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh | 
|  | * header to the ethernet header (if present). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame | 
|  | * @skb: the data frame | 
|  | * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use | 
|  | * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @eid: element ID | 
|  | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | 
|  | * @len: length of data | 
|  | * @match: byte array to match | 
|  | * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array | 
|  | * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match. | 
|  | *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers | 
|  | *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take | 
|  | *	the data portion instead. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if | 
|  | * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given | 
|  | * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the | 
|  | * requested element struct. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than | 
|  | * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the | 
|  | * byte array to match. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | const struct element * | 
|  | cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, | 
|  | const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, | 
|  | unsigned int match_offset); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @eid: element ID | 
|  | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | 
|  | * @len: length of data | 
|  | * @match: byte array to match | 
|  | * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array | 
|  | * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match. | 
|  | *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero. | 
|  | *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first | 
|  | *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and | 
|  | *	the second byte is the IE length. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if | 
|  | * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given | 
|  | * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first | 
|  | * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the | 
|  | * element ID. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than | 
|  | * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the | 
|  | * byte array to match. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline const u8 * | 
|  | cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, | 
|  | const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, | 
|  | unsigned int match_offset) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is | 
|  | * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) || | 
|  | (!match_len && match_offset))) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, | 
|  | match, match_len, | 
|  | match_offset ? | 
|  | match_offset - 2 : 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @eid: element ID | 
|  | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | 
|  | * @len: length of data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if | 
|  | * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given | 
|  | * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the | 
|  | * requested element struct. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than | 
|  | * having to fit into the given data. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline const struct element * | 
|  | cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @eid: element ID | 
|  | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | 
|  | * @len: length of data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if | 
|  | * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given | 
|  | * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested | 
|  | * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than | 
|  | * having to fit into the given data. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @ext_eid: element ID Extension | 
|  | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | 
|  | * @len: length of data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if | 
|  | * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given | 
|  | * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the | 
|  | * requested element struct. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than | 
|  | * having to fit into the given data. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline const struct element * | 
|  | cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, | 
|  | &ext_eid, 1, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @ext_eid: element ID Extension | 
|  | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | 
|  | * @len: length of data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if | 
|  | * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given | 
|  | * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested | 
|  | * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than | 
|  | * having to fit into the given data. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, | 
|  | &ext_eid, 1, 2); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @oui: vendor OUI | 
|  | * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any | 
|  | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | 
|  | * @len: length of data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the | 
|  | * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise | 
|  | * return the element structure for the requested element. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into | 
|  | * the given data. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, | 
|  | const u8 *ies, | 
|  | unsigned int len); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @oui: vendor OUI | 
|  | * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any | 
|  | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | 
|  | * @len: length of data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the | 
|  | * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to | 
|  | * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the | 
|  | * element ID. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into | 
|  | * the given data. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline const u8 * | 
|  | cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, | 
|  | const u8 *ies, unsigned int len) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @elem: the element to defragment | 
|  | * @ies: elements where @elem is contained | 
|  | * @ieslen: length of @ies | 
|  | * @data: buffer to store element data | 
|  | * @data_len: length of @data | 
|  | * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while | 
|  | * skipping all headers. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an | 
|  | * element in-place. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies, | 
|  | size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len, | 
|  | u8 frag_id); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @addr: STA MAC address | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge | 
|  | * devices upon STA association. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure | 
|  | * | 
|  | * TODO | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting | 
|  | *	conflicts) | 
|  | * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain | 
|  | *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you | 
|  | *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted | 
|  | *	alpha2. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core | 
|  | * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by | 
|  | * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory | 
|  | * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain. | 
|  | * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried | 
|  | * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call. | 
|  | * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(), | 
|  | * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw(). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get | 
|  | * an -ENOMEM. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on | 
|  | * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they | 
|  | * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more | 
|  | * information. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on | 
|  | * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and | 
|  | * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details | 
|  | * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on | 
|  | * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply | 
|  | * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory | 
|  | * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The | 
|  | * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous | 
|  | * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a | 
|  | * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled. | 
|  | * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag | 
|  | * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy | 
|  | * that called this helper. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for | 
|  | * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on | 
|  | * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain | 
|  | * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received | 
|  | * and processed already. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule | 
|  | * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to | 
|  | * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return | 
|  | * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even | 
|  | * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band. | 
|  | * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is | 
|  | * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | u32 center_freq); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name | 
|  | * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator | 
|  | * | 
|  | * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a | 
|  | * proper string representation. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom | 
|  | * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions | 
|  | * | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule | 
|  | * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried. | 
|  | * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried. | 
|  | * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query | 
|  | * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given | 
|  | * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get | 
|  | * an -ENODATA. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* | 
|  | * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification | 
|  | * functions and BSS handling helpers | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @request: the corresponding scan request | 
|  | * @info: information about the completed scan | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results | 
|  | * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped | 
|  | * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the | 
|  | * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver | 
|  | * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped | 
|  | * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the | 
|  | * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver | 
|  | * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. | 
|  | * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS | 
|  | * @data: the BSS metadata | 
|  | * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon) | 
|  | * @len: length of the management frame | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and | 
|  | * the BSS should be updated/added. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! | 
|  | * Or %NULL on error. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check | 
|  | cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check | 
|  | cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, | 
|  | enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, | 
|  | s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { | 
|  | .chan = rx_channel, | 
|  | .scan_width = scan_width, | 
|  | .signal = signal, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check | 
|  | cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, | 
|  | s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { | 
|  | .chan = rx_channel, | 
|  | .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, | 
|  | .signal = signal, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID | 
|  | * @bssid: transmitter BSSID | 
|  | * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element | 
|  | * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element | 
|  | * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid, | 
|  | u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid) | 
|  | { | 
|  | u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid); | 
|  | u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0); | 
|  | u64 new_bssid_u64; | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask; | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask; | 
|  |  | 
|  | u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited | 
|  | * @element: element to check | 
|  | * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element, | 
|  | const struct element *non_inherit_element); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs | 
|  | * @ie: ies | 
|  | * @ielen: length of IEs | 
|  | * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element | 
|  | * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile) | 
|  | * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile | 
|  | * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length | 
|  | */ | 
|  | size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, | 
|  | const struct element *mbssid_elem, | 
|  | const struct element *sub_elem, | 
|  | u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from | 
|  | * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is | 
|  | *	from a beacon or probe response | 
|  | * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon | 
|  | * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response | 
|  | */ | 
|  | enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type { | 
|  | CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN, | 
|  | CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON, | 
|  | CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies | 
|  | * @ie: IEs | 
|  | * @ielen: length of IEs | 
|  | * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Returns the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, | 
|  | enum nl80211_band band); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS | 
|  | * @data: the BSS metadata | 
|  | * @ftype: frame type (if known) | 
|  | * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS | 
|  | * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0) | 
|  | * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer | 
|  | * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer | 
|  | * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer | 
|  | * @ielen: length of the additional IEs | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and | 
|  | * the BSS should be updated/added. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! | 
|  | * Or %NULL on error. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check | 
|  | cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, | 
|  | enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, | 
|  | const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, | 
|  | u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check | 
|  | cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, | 
|  | enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, | 
|  | enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, | 
|  | const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, | 
|  | u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, | 
|  | s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { | 
|  | .chan = rx_channel, | 
|  | .scan_width = scan_width, | 
|  | .signal = signal, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, | 
|  | capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, | 
|  | gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check | 
|  | cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, | 
|  | enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, | 
|  | const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, | 
|  | u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, | 
|  | s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { | 
|  | .chan = rx_channel, | 
|  | .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, | 
|  | .signal = signal, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, | 
|  | capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, | 
|  | gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to | 
|  | * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL) | 
|  | * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL) | 
|  | * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL) | 
|  | * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0) | 
|  | * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type | 
|  | * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *channel, | 
|  | const u8 *bssid, | 
|  | const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, | 
|  | enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type, | 
|  | enum ieee80211_privacy privacy); | 
|  | static inline struct cfg80211_bss * | 
|  | cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *channel, | 
|  | const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len, | 
|  | IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, | 
|  | IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to | 
|  | * @bss: the BSS struct to reference | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to | 
|  | * @bss: the BSS struct | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @bss: the bss to remove | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures | 
|  | * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this | 
|  | * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time | 
|  | * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy | 
|  | * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not | 
|  | * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel | 
|  | *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel. | 
|  | * @iter: the iterator function to call | 
|  | * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss *bss, | 
|  | void *data), | 
|  | void *iter_data); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width | 
|  | cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (chandef->width) { | 
|  | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: | 
|  | return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5; | 
|  | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: | 
|  | return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @buf: authentication frame (header + body) | 
|  | * @len: length of the frame data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or | 
|  | * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode. | 
|  | * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must | 
|  | * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). | 
|  | * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must | 
|  | * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). | 
|  | * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed | 
|  | * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used | 
|  | * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function | 
|  | * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's | 
|  | * mutex. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - association response data | 
|  | * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer | 
|  | *	moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp() | 
|  | * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body) | 
|  | * @len: length of the frame data | 
|  | * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format | 
|  | *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field | 
|  | * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame | 
|  | * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data | 
|  | * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO) | 
|  | * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for | 
|  | *	non-MLO connections | 
|  | * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that | 
|  | *	were rejected by the AP. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp { | 
|  | const u8 *buf; | 
|  | size_t len; | 
|  | const u8 *req_ies; | 
|  | size_t req_ies_len; | 
|  | int uapsd_queues; | 
|  | const u8 *ap_mld_addr; | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss *bss; | 
|  | u16 status; | 
|  | } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp | 
|  | * | 
|  | * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must | 
|  | * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp *data); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data | 
|  | * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL | 
|  | * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections | 
|  | *	(@ap_mld_addr is %NULL) | 
|  | * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise | 
|  | *	the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some | 
|  | *	other API (e.g. deauth RX) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_assoc_failure { | 
|  | const u8 *ap_mld_addr; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | 
|  | bool timeout; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @data: data describing the association failure | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body) | 
|  | * @len: length of the frame data | 
|  | * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute) | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in | 
|  | * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and | 
|  | * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the | 
|  | * corresponding wdev's mutex. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len, | 
|  | bool reconnect); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @buf: received management frame (header + body) | 
|  | * @len: length of the frame data | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc | 
|  | * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the | 
|  | * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon | 
|  | * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while | 
|  | * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function may sleep. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *buf, size_t len); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP) | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame | 
|  | * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used | 
|  | * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing. | 
|  | * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets) | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a | 
|  | * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() | 
|  | * primitive. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, | 
|  | enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id, | 
|  | const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined | 
|  | * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or | 
|  | * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called, | 
|  | * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of | 
|  | * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called | 
|  | * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is | 
|  | * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer | 
|  | * 					candidate | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate | 
|  | * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate | 
|  | * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer | 
|  | * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been | 
|  | * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response. | 
|  | * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len, | 
|  | int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * DOC: RFkill integration | 
|  | * | 
|  | * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers, | 
|  | * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each | 
|  | * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated | 
|  | * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are | 
|  | * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they | 
|  | * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211. | 
|  | * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here. | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @blocked: block status | 
|  | * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked, | 
|  | enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked) | 
|  | { | 
|  | wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked, | 
|  | RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy) | 
|  | { | 
|  | rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * DOC: Vendor commands | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that | 
|  | * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the | 
|  | * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with | 
|  | * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as | 
|  | * the configuration mechanism. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array | 
|  | * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an | 
|  | * OUI and sub command ID to identify it. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol | 
|  | * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular, | 
|  | * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any | 
|  | * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection | 
|  | * managers etc. need. | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | enum nl80211_commands cmd, | 
|  | enum nl80211_attrs attr, | 
|  | int approxlen); | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | enum nl80211_commands cmd, | 
|  | enum nl80211_attrs attr, | 
|  | unsigned int portid, | 
|  | int vendor_event_idx, | 
|  | int approxlen, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will | 
|  | *	be put into the skb | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to | 
|  | * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling | 
|  | * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in | 
|  | * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), | 
|  | * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the | 
|  | * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done | 
|  | * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool | 
|  | * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute. | 
|  | * You must not modify the skb in any other way. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return | 
|  | * its error code as the result of the doit() operation. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline struct sk_buff * | 
|  | cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, | 
|  | NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb | 
|  | * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with | 
|  | *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb() | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing | 
|  | * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should | 
|  | * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the | 
|  | * skb regardless of the return value. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: An error code or 0 on success. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler. | 
|  | * Valid to call only there. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @wdev: the wireless device | 
|  | * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events | 
|  | * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will | 
|  | *	be put into the skb | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the | 
|  | * vendor-specific multicast group. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified | 
|  | * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data | 
|  | * attribute. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the | 
|  | * skb to send the event. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline struct sk_buff * | 
|  | cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, | 
|  | NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, | 
|  | 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @wdev: the wireless device | 
|  | * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events | 
|  | * @portid: port ID of the receiver | 
|  | * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will | 
|  | *	be put into the skb | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to | 
|  | * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been | 
|  | * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take | 
|  | * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified | 
|  | * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data | 
|  | * attribute. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the | 
|  | * skb to send the event. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline struct sk_buff * | 
|  | cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | unsigned int portid, int approxlen, | 
|  | int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, | 
|  | NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, | 
|  | portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event | 
|  | * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc() | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated | 
|  | * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * DOC: Test mode | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to | 
|  | * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance, | 
|  | * factory programming. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more | 
|  | * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it. | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will | 
|  | *	be put into the skb | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to | 
|  | * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling | 
|  | * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in | 
|  | * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), | 
|  | * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the | 
|  | * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done | 
|  | * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool | 
|  | * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You | 
|  | * must not modify the skb in any other way. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return | 
|  | * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline struct sk_buff * | 
|  | cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, | 
|  | NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb | 
|  | * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with | 
|  | *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing | 
|  | * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return | 
|  | * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb | 
|  | * regardless of the return value. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: An error code or 0 on success. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will | 
|  | *	be put into the skb | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the | 
|  | * testmode multicast group. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with | 
|  | * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As | 
|  | * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the | 
|  | * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb | 
|  | * in any other way. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the | 
|  | * skb to send the event. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline struct sk_buff * | 
|  | cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, | 
|  | NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1, | 
|  | approxlen, gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event | 
|  | * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with | 
|  | *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb() | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated | 
|  | * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always | 
|  | * consumes it. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd), | 
|  | #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd), | 
|  | #else | 
|  | #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) | 
|  | #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params | 
|  | * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL) | 
|  | * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets | 
|  | * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in | 
|  | *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid. | 
|  | * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in | 
|  | *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the | 
|  | *	status for a FILS connection. | 
|  | * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL). | 
|  | * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets | 
|  | * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID | 
|  | *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params { | 
|  | const u8 *kek; | 
|  | size_t kek_len; | 
|  | bool update_erp_next_seq_num; | 
|  | u16 erp_next_seq_num; | 
|  | const u8 *pmk; | 
|  | size_t pmk_len; | 
|  | const u8 *pmkid; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params | 
|  | * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use | 
|  | *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you | 
|  | *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a | 
|  | *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame | 
|  | *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to | 
|  | *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. | 
|  | *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that | 
|  | *	case. | 
|  | * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL) | 
|  | * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length | 
|  | * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL) | 
|  | * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length | 
|  | * @fils: FILS connection response parameters. | 
|  | * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the | 
|  | *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from | 
|  | *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is | 
|  | *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the | 
|  | *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. | 
|  | *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). | 
|  | * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise | 
|  | *	zero. | 
|  | * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL. | 
|  | * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated | 
|  | *	using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the | 
|  | *	connected AP info. | 
|  | * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise | 
|  | *	%NULL. | 
|  | * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO | 
|  | *	connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL). | 
|  | * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected. | 
|  | *	For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA | 
|  | *	is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be | 
|  | *	%NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and | 
|  | *	hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning | 
|  | *	if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers | 
|  | *	implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs | 
|  | *	to be specified. | 
|  | * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not | 
|  | *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the | 
|  | *	@valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params { | 
|  | int status; | 
|  | const u8 *req_ie; | 
|  | size_t req_ie_len; | 
|  | const u8 *resp_ie; | 
|  | size_t resp_ie_len; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; | 
|  | enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const u8 *ap_mld_addr; | 
|  | u16 valid_links; | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | const u8 *addr; | 
|  | const u8 *bssid; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss *bss; | 
|  | u16 status; | 
|  | } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @params: connection response parameters | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection | 
|  | * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response | 
|  | * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(), | 
|  | * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP | 
|  | * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through | 
|  | *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the | 
|  | *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return | 
|  | *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the | 
|  | *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. | 
|  | *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. | 
|  | * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) | 
|  | * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length | 
|  | * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) | 
|  | * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length | 
|  | * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use | 
|  | *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you | 
|  | *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a | 
|  | *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame | 
|  | *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to | 
|  | *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. | 
|  | *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that | 
|  | *	case. | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the | 
|  | *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from | 
|  | *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is | 
|  | *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the | 
|  | *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. | 
|  | *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection | 
|  | * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss | 
|  | * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void | 
|  | cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie, | 
|  | size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie, | 
|  | size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp, | 
|  | enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params; | 
|  |  | 
|  | memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params)); | 
|  | params.status = status; | 
|  | params.links[0].bssid = bssid; | 
|  | params.links[0].bss = bss; | 
|  | params.req_ie = req_ie; | 
|  | params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len; | 
|  | params.resp_ie = resp_ie; | 
|  | params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len; | 
|  | params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason; | 
|  |  | 
|  | cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP | 
|  | * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) | 
|  | * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length | 
|  | * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) | 
|  | * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length | 
|  | * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use | 
|  | *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you | 
|  | *	the real status code for failures. | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection | 
|  | * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only | 
|  | * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void | 
|  | cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, | 
|  | const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, | 
|  | const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len, | 
|  | u16 status, gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie, | 
|  | resp_ie_len, status, gfp, | 
|  | NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP | 
|  | * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) | 
|  | * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed | 
|  | * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was | 
|  | * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send | 
|  | * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while | 
|  | * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void | 
|  | cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, | 
|  | const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp, | 
|  | enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1, | 
|  | gfp, timeout_reason); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) | 
|  | * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length | 
|  | * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) | 
|  | * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length | 
|  | * @fils: FILS related roaming information. | 
|  | * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set. | 
|  | *	Otherwise zero. | 
|  | * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL. | 
|  | * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in | 
|  | *	@valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info. | 
|  | * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL. | 
|  | * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO | 
|  | *	roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be | 
|  | *	%NULL if %links.bss is set. | 
|  | * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP. | 
|  | * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got | 
|  | *	roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to | 
|  | *	which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_roam_info { | 
|  | const u8 *req_ie; | 
|  | size_t req_ie_len; | 
|  | const u8 *resp_ie; | 
|  | size_t resp_ie_len; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const u8 *ap_mld_addr; | 
|  | u16 valid_links; | 
|  | struct { | 
|  | const u8 *addr; | 
|  | const u8 *bssid; | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *channel; | 
|  | struct cfg80211_bss *bss; | 
|  | } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info. | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the | 
|  | * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry. | 
|  | * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP | 
|  | * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in | 
|  | * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where | 
|  | * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the | 
|  | * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling | 
|  | * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released | 
|  | * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be | 
|  | * released while disconnecting from the current bss. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP | 
|  | * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy | 
|  | * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake | 
|  | * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e., | 
|  | * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function | 
|  | * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(), | 
|  | * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to | 
|  | * indicate the 802.11 association. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, | 
|  | const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL) | 
|  | * @ie_len: length of IEs | 
|  | * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown | 
|  | * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state | 
|  | * and not try to connect to any AP any more. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason, | 
|  | const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len, | 
|  | bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start | 
|  | * @wdev: wireless device | 
|  | * @cookie: the request cookie | 
|  | * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) | 
|  | * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the | 
|  | *	channel | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *chan, | 
|  | unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired | 
|  | * @wdev: wireless device | 
|  | * @cookie: the request cookie | 
|  | * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *chan, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired | 
|  | * @wdev: wireless device | 
|  | * @cookie: the requested cookie | 
|  | * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request) | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, | 
|  | struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @sinfo: the station information | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info | 
|  | * @sinfo: the station information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station | 
|  | * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on | 
|  | * the stack.) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo) | 
|  | { | 
|  | kfree(sinfo->pertid); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dev: the netdev | 
|  | * @mac_addr: the station's address | 
|  | * @sinfo: the station information | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, | 
|  | struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station | 
|  | * @dev: the netdev | 
|  | * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used. | 
|  | * @sinfo: the station information/statistics | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, | 
|  | struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dev: the netdev | 
|  | * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used. | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @dev: the netdev | 
|  | * @mac_addr: the station's address | 
|  | * @reason: the reason for connection failure | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station | 
|  | * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection | 
|  | * for some reasons, this function is called. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from | 
|  | * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, | 
|  | enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz | 
|  | * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown | 
|  | * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of | 
|  | *	an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid | 
|  | * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received	on | 
|  | * @buf: Management frame (header + body) | 
|  | * @len: length of the frame data | 
|  | * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags | 
|  | * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds | 
|  | * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_rx_info { | 
|  | int freq; | 
|  | int sig_dbm; | 
|  | bool have_link_id; | 
|  | u8 link_id; | 
|  | const u8 *buf; | 
|  | size_t len; | 
|  | u32 flags; | 
|  | u64 rx_tstamp; | 
|  | u64 ack_tstamp; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info | 
|  | * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame | 
|  | * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station | 
|  | * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. | 
|  | * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized | 
|  | * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the | 
|  | * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_rx_info *info); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame | 
|  | * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame | 
|  | * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz | 
|  | * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown | 
|  | * @buf: Management frame (header + body) | 
|  | * @len: length of the frame data | 
|  | * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station | 
|  | * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. | 
|  | * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized | 
|  | * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the | 
|  | * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, | 
|  | int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, | 
|  | u32 flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_rx_info info = { | 
|  | .freq = freq, | 
|  | .sig_dbm = sig_dbm, | 
|  | .buf = buf, | 
|  | .len = len, | 
|  | .flags = flags | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame | 
|  | * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame | 
|  | * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz | 
|  | * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown | 
|  | * @buf: Management frame (header + body) | 
|  | * @len: length of the frame data | 
|  | * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station | 
|  | * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. | 
|  | * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized | 
|  | * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the | 
|  | * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, | 
|  | int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, | 
|  | u32 flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_rx_info info = { | 
|  | .freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), | 
|  | .sig_dbm = sig_dbm, | 
|  | .buf = buf, | 
|  | .len = len, | 
|  | .flags = flags | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() | 
|  | * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds | 
|  | * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds | 
|  | * @buf: Management frame (header + body) | 
|  | * @len: length of the frame data | 
|  | * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_tx_status { | 
|  | u64 cookie; | 
|  | u64 tx_tstamp; | 
|  | u64 ack_tstamp; | 
|  | const u8 *buf; | 
|  | size_t len; | 
|  | bool ack; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info | 
|  | * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame | 
|  | * @status: TX status data | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be | 
|  | * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the | 
|  | * transmission attempt with extended info. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame | 
|  | * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame | 
|  | * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() | 
|  | * @buf: Management frame (header + body) | 
|  | * @len: length of the frame data | 
|  | * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be | 
|  | * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the | 
|  | * transmission attempt. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | u64 cookie, const u8 *buf, | 
|  | size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cfg80211_tx_status status = { | 
|  | .cookie = cookie, | 
|  | .buf = buf, | 
|  | .len = len, | 
|  | .ack = ack | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control | 
|  | *                                   port frames | 
|  | * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame | 
|  | * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() | 
|  | * @buf: Data frame (header + body) | 
|  | * @len: length of the frame data | 
|  | * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be | 
|  | * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of | 
|  | * the transmission attempt. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, | 
|  | const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame | 
|  | * @dev: The device the frame matched to | 
|  | * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf | 
|  | *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear. | 
|  | *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is | 
|  | *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that | 
|  | *	skb->protocol is set appropriately. | 
|  | * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted | 
|  | * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port | 
|  | * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive | 
|  | * control port frames over nl80211. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all | 
|  | * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame). | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb, | 
|  | bool unencrypted, int link_id); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event | 
|  | * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring | 
|  | * rssi threshold reached event occurs. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, | 
|  | s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @peer: peer's MAC address | 
|  | * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold | 
|  | *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent | 
|  | *	threshold (to account for temporary interference) | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @peer: peer's MAC address | 
|  | * @num_packets: how many packets were lost | 
|  | * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission | 
|  | * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached. | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a | 
|  | * given interval is exceeded. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, | 
|  | u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @chandef: chandef for the current channel | 
|  | * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | bool offchan, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline void | 
|  | cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline void | 
|  | cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified | 
|  | * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action | 
|  | * frame. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac, | 
|  | struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event | 
|  | * @netdev: network device | 
|  | * @chandef: chandef for the current channel | 
|  | * @event: type of event | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished | 
|  | * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process, | 
|  | * also by full-MAC drivers. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev, | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check | 
|  | * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races) | 
|  | * @replay_ctr: new replay counter | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, | 
|  | const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority) | 
|  | * @bssid: BSSID of AP | 
|  | * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index, | 
|  | const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame | 
|  | * @dev: The device the frame matched to | 
|  | * @addr: the transmitter address | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that | 
|  | * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the | 
|  | * sender. | 
|  | * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed | 
|  | * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame | 
|  | * @dev: The device the frame matched to | 
|  | * @addr: the transmitter address | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that | 
|  | * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected. | 
|  | * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each | 
|  | * station to avoid event flooding. | 
|  | * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed | 
|  | * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status | 
|  | * @dev: the device the probe was sent on | 
|  | * @addr: the address of the peer | 
|  | * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously | 
|  | * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not | 
|  | * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame. | 
|  | * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not. | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, | 
|  | u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal, | 
|  | bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs | 
|  | * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon | 
|  | * @frame: the frame | 
|  | * @len: length of the frame | 
|  | * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz | 
|  | * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was | 
|  | * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no | 
|  | * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame, | 
|  | size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs | 
|  | * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon | 
|  | * @frame: the frame | 
|  | * @len: length of the frame | 
|  | * @freq: frequency the frame was received on | 
|  | * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was | 
|  | * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no | 
|  | * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | const u8 *frame, size_t len, | 
|  | int freq, int sig_dbm) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), | 
|  | sig_dbm); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @chandef: the channel definition | 
|  | * @iftype: interface type | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) | 
|  | * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | enum nl80211_iftype iftype); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @chandef: the channel definition | 
|  | * @iftype: interface type | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) | 
|  | * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version | 
|  | * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under | 
|  | * more permissive conditions. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | enum nl80211_iftype iftype); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* | 
|  | * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace | 
|  | * @dev: the device which switched channels | 
|  | * @chandef: the new channel definition | 
|  | * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO | 
|  | * @punct_bitmap: the new puncturing bitmap | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable | 
|  | * driver context! | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | unsigned int link_id, u16 punct_bitmap); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* | 
|  | * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start | 
|  | * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started | 
|  | * @chandef: the future channel definition | 
|  | * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO | 
|  | * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens | 
|  | * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP | 
|  | * @punct_bitmap: the future puncturing bitmap | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just | 
|  | * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting | 
|  | * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | unsigned int link_id, u8 count, | 
|  | bool quiet, u16 punct_bitmap); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @operating_class: the operating class to convert | 
|  | * @band: band pointer to fill | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class, | 
|  | enum nl80211_band *band); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @chandef: the chandef to convert | 
|  | * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | 
|  | u8 *op_class); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @chandef: the chandef to convert | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline u32 | 
|  | ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* | 
|  | * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation | 
|  | * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested | 
|  | * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device | 
|  | * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or | 
|  | *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN) | 
|  | * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that | 
|  | * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP | 
|  | * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use | 
|  | * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g., | 
|  | * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, | 
|  | enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, | 
|  | u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* | 
|  | * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units) | 
|  | * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from | 
|  | * | 
|  | * return 0 if MCS index >= 32 | 
|  | */ | 
|  | u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev | 
|  | * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary | 
|  | * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device | 
|  | * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called | 
|  | * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device | 
|  | * is unbound from the driver. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev | 
|  | * @dev: the netdev to register | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather | 
|  | * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is | 
|  | * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable | 
|  | * instead as well. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev | 
|  | * @dev: the netdev to register | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather | 
|  | * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL | 
|  | * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are | 
|  | * usable instead as well. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev) | 
|  | { | 
|  | #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) | 
|  | cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr); | 
|  | #endif | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements | 
|  | * @ies: FT IEs | 
|  | * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes | 
|  | * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address | 
|  | * @ric_ies: RIC IE | 
|  | * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ft_event_params { | 
|  | const u8 *ies; | 
|  | size_t ies_len; | 
|  | const u8 *target_ap; | 
|  | const u8 *ric_ies; | 
|  | size_t ric_ies_len; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE | 
|  | * @netdev: network device | 
|  | * @ft_event: IE information | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer | 
|  | * @ies: the input IE buffer | 
|  | * @len: the input length | 
|  | * @attr: the attribute ID to find | 
|  | * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g. | 
|  | *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size | 
|  | * @bufsize: size of the output buffer | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and | 
|  | * copies its contents to the given buffer. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is | 
|  | * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the | 
|  | * length of the found attribute (which can be zero). | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, | 
|  | enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr, | 
|  | u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC) | 
|  | * @ies: the IE buffer | 
|  | * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer | 
|  | * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before | 
|  | *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next | 
|  | *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. | 
|  | * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array | 
|  | * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element | 
|  | * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array | 
|  | * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset | 
|  | * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be | 
|  | * split. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this | 
|  | * has to be guaranteed by the caller! | 
|  | * | 
|  | * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered | 
|  | * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not | 
|  | * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The function returns the offset where the next part of the | 
|  | * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) | 
|  | * of the buffer should be used. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, | 
|  | const u8 *ids, int n_ids, | 
|  | const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric, | 
|  | size_t offset); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering | 
|  | * @ies: the IE buffer | 
|  | * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer | 
|  | * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before | 
|  | *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next | 
|  | *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. | 
|  | * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array | 
|  | * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset | 
|  | * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be | 
|  | * split. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this | 
|  | * has to be guaranteed by the caller! | 
|  | * | 
|  | * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered | 
|  | * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not | 
|  | * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The function returns the offset where the next part of the | 
|  | * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) | 
|  | * of the buffer should be used. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, | 
|  | const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN | 
|  | * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup | 
|  | * @wakeup: the wakeup report | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it | 
|  | * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may | 
|  | * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something | 
|  | * else caused the wakeup. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped. | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted | 
|  | * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given | 
|  | * by .crit_proto_start() has expired. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: the number of channels supported by the device. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @params: the interface combinations parameter | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a | 
|  | * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to | 
|  | * the interface combinations. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct iface_combination_params *params); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @params: the interface combinations parameter | 
|  | * @iter: function to call for each matching combination | 
|  | * @data: pointer to pass to iter function | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible | 
|  | * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching | 
|  | * purposes. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | struct iface_combination_params *params, | 
|  | void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c, | 
|  | void *data), | 
|  | void *data); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* | 
|  | * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @wdev: wireless device | 
|  | * @gfp: context flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA | 
|  | * disconnected. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by | 
|  | * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed). | 
|  | * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors | 
|  | * that really can't be recovered in any other way. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into | 
|  | * the driver while the function is running. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. | 
|  | * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see | 
|  | * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) | 
|  | { | 
|  | u8 *ft_byte; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; | 
|  | *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. | 
|  | * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see | 
|  | * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline bool | 
|  | wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy, | 
|  | enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) | 
|  | { | 
|  | u8 ft_byte; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; | 
|  | return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function | 
|  | * @f: NAN function that should be freed | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters | 
|  | * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is | 
|  | *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber. | 
|  | *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery | 
|  | *	 result. | 
|  | *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up. | 
|  | * @inst_id: the local instance id | 
|  | * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function | 
|  | * @addr: the MAC address of the peer | 
|  | * @info_len: the length of the &info | 
|  | * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any) | 
|  | * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function | 
|  | */ | 
|  | struct cfg80211_nan_match_params { | 
|  | enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; | 
|  | u8 inst_id; | 
|  | u8 peer_inst_id; | 
|  | const u8 *addr; | 
|  | u8 info_len; | 
|  | const u8 *info; | 
|  | u64 cookie; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function. | 
|  | * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match | 
|  | * @match: match notification parameters | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This | 
|  | * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that | 
|  | * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match | 
|  | * @inst_id: the local instance id | 
|  | * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) | 
|  | * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | u8 inst_id, | 
|  | enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, | 
|  | u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* ethtool helper */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication | 
|  | * @netdev: network device | 
|  | * @params: External authentication parameters | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data | 
|  | * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement | 
|  | * @req: the original measurement request | 
|  | * @result: the result data | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed | 
|  | * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement | 
|  | * @req: the original measurement request | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this | 
|  | * the request pointer will no longer be valid. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | * @iftype: interface type | 
|  | * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1' | 
|  | * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API | 
|  | * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when | 
|  | * check_swif is '1'. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, | 
|  | bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif); | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was | 
|  | * temporarly rejected with a comeback | 
|  | * @netdev: network device | 
|  | * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the assocation | 
|  | * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev, | 
|  | const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\ | 
|  | dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | 
|  | #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\ | 
|  | dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | 
|  | #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\ | 
|  | dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | 
|  | #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\ | 
|  | dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | 
|  | #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\ | 
|  | dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | 
|  | #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\ | 
|  | dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | 
|  | #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\ | 
|  | dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | 
|  | #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\ | 
|  | dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | 
|  | #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...)			\ | 
|  | dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\ | 
|  | dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | 
|  | #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\ | 
|  | dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\ | 
|  | wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args) | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\ | 
|  | dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | 
|  |  | 
|  | #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG) | 
|  | #define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg | 
|  | #else | 
|  | #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\ | 
|  | ({									\ | 
|  | if (0)								\ | 
|  | wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\ | 
|  | 0;								\ | 
|  | }) | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* | 
|  | * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference | 
|  | * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the | 
|  | * file/line information and a backtrace. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\ | 
|  | WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space | 
|  | * @netdev: network device | 
|  | * @owe_info: peer's owe info | 
|  | * @gfp: allocation flags | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev, | 
|  | struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info, | 
|  | gfp_t gfp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries | 
|  | * @wiphy: the wiphy | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify | 
|  | * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens | 
|  | * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of | 
|  | */ | 
|  | int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count, | 
|  | u64 color_bitmap); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision | 
|  | * @dev: network device | 
|  | * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | u64 color_bitmap) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION, | 
|  | 0, color_bitmap); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start | 
|  | * @dev: the device on which the color is switched | 
|  | * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, | 
|  | u8 count) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED, | 
|  | count, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort | 
|  | * @dev: the device on which the color is switched | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED, | 
|  | 0, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion | 
|  | * @dev: the device on which the color was switched | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, | 
|  | NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED, | 
|  | 0, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap - validate puncturing bitmap | 
|  | * @bitmap: bitmap to be validated | 
|  | * @chandef: channel definition | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Validate the puncturing bitmap. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Return: %true if the bitmap is valid. %false otherwise. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | bool cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap(u16 *bitmap, | 
|  | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /** | 
|  | * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links. | 
|  | * @dev: network device. | 
|  | * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs. | 
|  | * | 
|  | * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to | 
|  | * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link | 
|  | * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this | 
|  | * case disconnect instead. | 
|  | * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask); | 
|  |  | 
|  | #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */ |